blob: fa246ff3ffdd054a72faf93e28efb57cced671aa [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Christopher Fauletec554342022-09-28 14:51:49 +02006 2022/09/28
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007
8
9This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
18 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
19 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020020 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
22 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
23 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020024 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025
26
27Summary
28-------
29
301. Quick reminder about HTTP
311.1. The HTTP transaction model
321.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100331.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341.2.2. The request headers
351.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371.3.2. The response headers
38
392. Configuring HAProxy
402.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200422.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100432.4. Conditional blocks
442.5. Time format
452.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001018.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001038.3. Advanced logging options
1048.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1058.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1068.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1078.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1088.4. Timing events
1098.5. Session state at disconnection
1108.6. Non-printable characters
1118.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1128.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1138.9. Examples of logs
114
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001159. Supported filters
1169.1. Trace
1179.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001189.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001199.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001209.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001219.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200122
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012310. FastCGI applications
12410.1. Setup
12510.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12610.1.2. Proxy section
12710.1.3. Example
12810.2. Default parameters
12910.3. Limitations
130
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013111. Address formats
13211.1. Address family prefixes
13311.2. Socket type prefixes
13411.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135
1361. Quick reminder about HTTP
137----------------------------
138
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100139When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
141on almost anything found in the contents.
142
143However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
144formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
145correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
146
147
1481.1. The HTTP transaction model
149-------------------------------
150
151The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100152to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100153from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
154connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155will involve a new connection :
156
157 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
158
159In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
160establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
161by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
162length.
163
164Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
165to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
166however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
167response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
168header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
169
170 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
171
172Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
173power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
174but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200175a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100177Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
179second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
180page :
181
182 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
183
184This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
185latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
186correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
187the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100188server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100190The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
191time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
192are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
193parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
194carry the stream identifier.
195
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100196By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
197connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
198leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100199start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
200processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
201waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200202
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200203HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100204 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
205 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100206 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100207 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200208 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100209
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100210
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211
2121.2. HTTP request
213-----------------
214
215First, let's consider this HTTP request :
216
217 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100218 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
220 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
221 3 User-agent: my small browser
222 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
223 5 Accept: image/png
224
225
2261.2.1. The Request line
227-----------------------
228
229Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
230
231 - a METHOD : GET
232 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
233 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
234
235All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
236which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
237followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
238is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
239desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
240the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
241
242The URI itself can have several forms :
243
244 - A "relative URI" :
245
246 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
247
248 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
249 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
250
251 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
252
253 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
254
255 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
256 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
257 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
258 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
259 must accept this form too.
260
261 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
262 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
263 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100264
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200265 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
266 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
267 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
268 other protocols too.
269
270In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
271mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
272on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
273It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
274specific to the language, framework or application in use.
275
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100276HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100277assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100278
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200279
2801.2.2. The request headers
281--------------------------
282
283The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
284beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
285an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
286Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
287values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
288encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
289the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
290define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
291
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100292Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200293their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100294"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200295as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
296normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
297representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
298HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299
300The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
301that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
302is one valid form of empty line.
303
304Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
305headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
306about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
307application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
308
309Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000310 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200311 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
312 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
313 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
314
315
3161.3. HTTP response
317------------------
318
319An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
320messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
321
322 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100323 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200324 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
325 2 Content-length: 350
326 3 Content-Type: text/html
327
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200328As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
329codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
330response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100331continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
332the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
333following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
334sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
335(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
336correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
337such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
338state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400339over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100340if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
341information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200343
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003441.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345------------------------
346
347Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
348
349 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
350 - a status code : 200
351 - a reason : OK
352
353The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
355 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
356 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
357 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
358 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000360Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100361"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
363messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
364or "Authentication Required".
365
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100366HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200367
368 Code When / reason
369 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
370 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100373 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
374 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 400 for an invalid or too large request
376 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
377 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200378 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100379 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200380 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100381 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
382 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400383 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200384 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400385 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100386 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200387 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200388 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200389 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
390 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
391 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
392
393The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3944.2).
395
396
3971.3.2. The response headers
398---------------------------
399
400Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
401the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
402details.
403
404
4052. Configuring HAProxy
406----------------------
407
4082.1. Configuration file format
409------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200410
411HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
412
413 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100414 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700415 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100416 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200417
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100418The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
419a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100420
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100421 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
422
423 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
424
425 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
426 tab characters
427
428 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
429 keyword sequences listed in this document
430
431 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
432 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
433 parts of the configuration, or expressions
434
435 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
436 are supported
437
438 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
439 section
440
441This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
442generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
443figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
444
445First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
446the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
447a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
448word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
449follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
450the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
451the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
452the parts that need to be addressed.
453
454A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
455requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
456extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
457the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
458section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
459section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
460not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
461
462A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
463each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
464a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
465start a new one.
466
467Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
468that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
469applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
470"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
471processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
472ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
473which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
474In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
475of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
476identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
477such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4782, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
479
480 listen foo
481 bind :80
482
483 listen bar
484 bind :81
485
486Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
487spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
488of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
489following configurations are strictly equivalent:
490
491 global#this is the global section
492 daemon#daemonize
493 frontend foo
494 mode http # or tcp
495
496and:
497
498 global
499 daemon
500
501 # this is the public web frontend
502 frontend foo
503 mode http
504
505The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
506new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
507other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
508section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
509section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
510at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
511
512Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
513are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
514editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
515support automatic indent.
516
517In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
518positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
519modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
520anymore, and is not recommended.
521
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200522
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005232.2. Quoting and escaping
524-------------------------
525
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100526In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
527that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
528possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
529in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
530('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200531
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100532This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
533very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
534the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
535also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
536delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
537word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
538remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200539
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100540If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
541(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
542
543Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
544backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200545
546 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
547 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
548 \\ to use a backslash
549 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
550 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
551
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100552In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
553C-language representation:
554
555 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
556 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
557 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
558 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
559
560Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
561or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
562of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200563
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100564 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200565 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
566 # hash as a comment start
567
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100568Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
569evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
570dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
571backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200572
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100573Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
574character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
575is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200576
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100577As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
578entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
579name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
580represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
581hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200582
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100583 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
584 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
585 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
586 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
587 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
588 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
589 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
590 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
591 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
592 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
593 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200594
595 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100596 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200597 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
598 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
599 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
600 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
602
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100603There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
604necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
605by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
606they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
607escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
608characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
609case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
610if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
611own quotes.
612
613The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600614quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500615not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100616quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
617
618Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
619arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
620
621 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
622 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
623
624Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
625"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
626cannot write:
627
628 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
629
630because we would like the string to cut like this:
631
632 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
633 |---------|----|-|
634 arg1 _/ / /
635 arg2 __________/ /
636 arg3 ______________/
637
638but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
639parenthesis then garbage:
640
641 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
642 |--------|--------|
643 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
644 trailing garbage _________/
645
646The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
647quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
648processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
649this word:
650
651 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
652 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
653 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
654
655So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
656still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
657the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
658the second level:
659
660 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
661 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
662 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
663 |---------||----|-|
664 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
665 arg2=blah ___________/ /
666 arg3=g _______________/
667
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500668Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100669double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
670
671 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
672 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
673 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
674 |---------||----|-|
675 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
676 arg2 ___________/ /
677 arg3 _______________/
678
679When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
680appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
681string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
682thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
683
684 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
685 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
686 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
687 |-------------| |-----||-|
688 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
689 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
690 arg3 ______________________/
691
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400692Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600693that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100694quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
695single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
696level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
697
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600698Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
699if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
700or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
701
702 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
703 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
704 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
705
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100706When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
707double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600708and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100709a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
710a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
711the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
712regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
713around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
714more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200715
716
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007172.3. Environment variables
718--------------------------
719
720HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
721interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
722configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
723optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
724shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200725underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
726list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
727arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
728before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200729
730 Example:
731
732 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
733
734 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
735
736 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
737
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200738Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
739file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200740
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200741* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
742 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
743
744* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
745 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
746 directory.
747
748* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
749
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500750* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200751 processes, separated by semicolons.
752
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500753* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200754 CLI, separated by semicolons.
755
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200756In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
757regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
758only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
759
760* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
761
762* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
763 starting at one.
764
765* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
766 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
767 first section.
768
769These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
770if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
771section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
772"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
773proxies.
774
775This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
776logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
777to name some config objects like servers for example.
778
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200779See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200780
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100781
7822.4. Conditional blocks
783-----------------------
784
785It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
786some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
787ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
788configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
789versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
790preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
791text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
792lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
793switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
794are defined to form conditional blocks:
795
796 - .if <condition>
797 - .elif <condition>
798 - .else
799 - .endif
800
801The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
802as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
803matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
804there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
805only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
806".elif" of a block.
807
808Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
809ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
810as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
811
812The conditions are currently limited to:
813
814 - an empty string, always returns "false"
815 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
816 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200817 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
818
819The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
820
821 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
822 exists, regardless of its contents
823
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200824 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
825 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
826 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
827
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200828 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
829 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
830
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200831 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
832 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
833 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
834 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
835
836 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
837 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
838 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
839 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
840
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200841Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100842
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200843 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
844 listen mwcli_px
845 bind :1111
846 ...
847 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100848
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200849 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
850 bind :80
851 .endif
852
853 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200854 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200855 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200856 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200857 .endif
858
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200859 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
860 profiling.memory on
861 .endif
862
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200863Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100864
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200865 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100866 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
867 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
868 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
869
870Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
871"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
872fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
873provide advice to the user.
874
875Example:
876
877 .if "${A}"
878 .if "${B}"
879 .notice "A=1, B=1"
880 .elif "${C}"
881 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
882 .elif "${D}"
883 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
884 .else
885 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
886 .endif
887 .else
888 .notice "A=0"
889 .endif
890
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200891 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
892 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
893
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100894
8952.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200896----------------
897
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100898Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100899values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
900otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
901numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
902for every keyword. Supported units are :
903
904 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
905 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
906 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
907 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
908 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
909 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
910
911
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009122.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200913-------------
914
915 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
916 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
917 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
918 global
919 daemon
920 maxconn 256
921
922 defaults
923 mode http
924 timeout connect 5000ms
925 timeout client 50000ms
926 timeout server 50000ms
927
928 frontend http-in
929 bind *:80
930 default_backend servers
931
932 backend servers
933 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
934
935
936 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
937 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
938 global
939 daemon
940 maxconn 256
941
942 defaults
943 mode http
944 timeout connect 5000ms
945 timeout client 50000ms
946 timeout server 50000ms
947
948 listen http-in
949 bind *:80
950 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
951
952
953Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
954
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100955 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200956
957
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009583. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200959--------------------
960
961Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
962are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
963of them have command-line equivalents.
964
965The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
966
967 * Process management and security
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100968 - 51degrees-cache-size
969 - 51degrees-data-file
970 - 51degrees-property-name-list
971 - 51degrees-property-separator
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200972 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200973 - chroot
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200974 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100975 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200976 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200977 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200978 - description
979 - deviceatlas-json-file
980 - deviceatlas-log-level
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200981 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100982 - deviceatlas-separator
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +0200983 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900984 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200985 - gid
986 - group
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200987 - h1-case-adjust
988 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100989 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
990 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100991 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100992 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100993 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200994 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200995 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100996 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100997 - log-tag
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200998 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +0100999 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001000 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001001 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001002 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001003 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001004 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001005 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001007 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001008 - presetenv
1009 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001010 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001011 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001012 - setenv
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001013 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001014 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001015 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001016 - ssl-default-bind-options
1017 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001018 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001019 - ssl-default-server-options
1020 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001021 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001022 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001023 - stats
1024 - strict-limits
1025 - uid
1026 - ulimit-n
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001027 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001028 - unsetenv
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001029 - user
1030 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001031 - wurfl-data-file
1032 - wurfl-information-list
1033 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001034
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001035 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001036 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001037 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001038 - maxcompcpuusage
1039 - maxcomprate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001040 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001041 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001042 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001043 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001044 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001045 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001046 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau85dd5212022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001047 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001048 - noepoll
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001049 - noevports
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001050 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001051 - nokqueue
1052 - nopoll
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001053 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001054 - nosplice
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001055 - profiling.tasks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001056 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001057 - server-state-file
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001058 - spread-checks
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001059 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001060 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001061 - tune.buffers.limit
1062 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001063 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001064 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001065 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001066 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001067 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001068 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001069 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001070 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001071 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001072 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001073 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001074 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001075 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001076 - tune.lua.maxmem
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001077 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001078 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1079 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001080 - tune.maxaccept
1081 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001082 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001083 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001084 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001085 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1086 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001087 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1088 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001089 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001090 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001091 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001092 - tune.sndbuf.client
1093 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001094 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001095 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
1096 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
1097 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001098 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001099 - tune.ssl.lifetime
1100 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001101 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001102 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001103 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001104 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1105 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1106 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001107 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1108 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001109
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001110 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001111 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001112 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001113
1114
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011153.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001116------------------------------------
1117
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100111851degrees-data-file <file path>
1119 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1120 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1121
1122 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1123 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1124
112551degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
1126 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1127 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1128 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1129
1130 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1131 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1132
113351degrees-property-separator <char>
1134 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1135 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1136
1137 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1138 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1139
114051degrees-cache-size <number>
1141 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1142 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1143 By default, this cache is disabled.
1144
1145 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1146 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1147
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001148ca-base <dir>
1149 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001150 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1151 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1152 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001153
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001154chroot <jail dir>
1155 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1156 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1157 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1158 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1159 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001160 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001161
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001162cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1163 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1164 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1165 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1166 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1167 set. These sets have the format
1168
1169 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1170
1171 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001172 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001173 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1174 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001175 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1176 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001177 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1178 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1179 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1180 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1181 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1182 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1183 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1184 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1185 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1186 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001187
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001188 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1189 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1190 on the machine's word size.
1191
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001192 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001193 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1194 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1195 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1196 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1197 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1198 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001199
1200 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001201 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1202
1203 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1204 # first 4 CPUs
1205
1206 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1207 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1208 # word size.
1209
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001210 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001211 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001212 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1213 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1214 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1215
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001216 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1217 # and so on.
1218 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1219 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1220 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1221
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001222 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001223 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1224 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1225 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1226
1227 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1228 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1229 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1230
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001231 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1232 # and a thread range.
1233 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1234 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1235 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1236
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001237crt-base <dir>
1238 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001239 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1240 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001241
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001242daemon
1243 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1244 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001245 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1246 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001247
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001248default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001249 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001250 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1251 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1252 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1253 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1254 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1255 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1256 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1257 not start with a slash ('/'):
1258 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1259 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1260
1261 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1262 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1263 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1264 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1265 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1266 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1267 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1268 each of them.
1269
1270 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1271 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1272 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1273 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1274 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1275 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1276 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1277 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1278
1279 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1280 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001281 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001282 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1283 made easily relocatable.
1284
1285 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1286 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1287 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1288 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1289 consistent across all configuration files.
1290
1291 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1292 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1293 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1294 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1295 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1296 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1297 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1298 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1299
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001300description <text>
1301 Add a text that describes the instance.
1302
1303 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1304 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1305 "<" and ">" characters.
1306
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001307deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1308 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001309 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001310
1311deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001312 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001313 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1314
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001315deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001316 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1317 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1318 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001319
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001320deviceatlas-separator <char>
1321 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1322 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1323
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001324expose-experimental-directives
1325 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1326 the config file will be rejected.
1327
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001328external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001329 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1330 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001331 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1332 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1333 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1334 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1335 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001336
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001337gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001338 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001339 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1340 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001341 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001342 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001343 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001344
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001345group <group name>
1346 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1347 See also "gid" and "user".
1348
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001349h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1350 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1351 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1352 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1353 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001354 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001355 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1356 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1357 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1358 specified in a proxy.
1359
1360 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1361 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1362 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1363 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1364 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1365 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1366 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1367
1368 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1369 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1370 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1371 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1372 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1373
1374 Example:
1375 global
1376 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1377
1378 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1379 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1380
1381h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1382 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1383 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1384 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1385 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1386 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1387 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1388 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1389 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1390
1391 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1392 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1393 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1394
1395 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1396 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1397
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001398h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1399 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1400 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1401 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1402 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1403 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1404 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1405 the keyword with "no'.
1406
1407hard-stop-after <time>
1408 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1409
1410 Arguments :
1411 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1412 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1413 SIGUSR1 signal.
1414
1415 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1416 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1417 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1418
1419 Example:
1420 global
1421 hard-stop-after 30s
1422
1423 See also: grace
1424
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001425insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001426 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001427 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1428 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1429 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1430 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1431 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1432 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1433 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001434 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001435 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1436 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1437 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1438 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1439 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1440 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1441 disable it.
1442
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001443insecure-setuid-wanted
1444 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1445 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1446 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1447 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001448 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001449 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001450 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001451 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1452 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001453 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001454 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1455 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1456 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1457 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1458
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001459issuers-chain-path <dir>
1460 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1461 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1462 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001463 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001464 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1465 "issuers-chain-path".
1466 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1467 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1468 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1469 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1470 will share the chain in memory.
1471
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001472localpeer <name>
1473 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1474 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1475 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1476 the configuration parsing.
1477
1478 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1479 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1480
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001481log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001482 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001483 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001484 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001485 configured with "log global".
1486
1487 <address> can be one of:
1488
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001489 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001490 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1491 port).
1492
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001493 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1494 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1495 port).
1496
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001497 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001498 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1499 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001500 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001501
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001502 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1503 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1504 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1505 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1506 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1507 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1508 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1509 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1510 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1511 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001512 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001513 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1514 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1515 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001516 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1517 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001518
1519 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1520 "fd@2", see above.
1521
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001522 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1523 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1524 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1525 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1526 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1527
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001528 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1529 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001530
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001531 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1532 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1533 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1534 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1535 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1536 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1537 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1538 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1539 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1540 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001541 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1542 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001543
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001544 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1545 one of the following :
1546
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001547 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1548 field is stripped. This is the default.
1549 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1550 rfc3164.
1551
1552 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001553 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1554
1555 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1556 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1557
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001558 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1559 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1560 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1561 designed to be used with a local log server.
1562
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001563 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1564 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1565 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1566 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1567 logger consumes.
1568
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001569 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1570 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1571 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1572 used with a local log server.
1573
1574 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1575 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1576 designed to be used with a local log server.
1577
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001578 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1579 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1580 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1581 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1582
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001583 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1584 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1585 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1586 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1587 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1588
1589 <sample_size>
1590 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1591 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1592 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1593 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1594 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1595
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001596 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001597
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001598 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1599 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1600 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1601
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001602 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1603 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1604 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1605 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001606
1607 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001608 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1609 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1610 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1611 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1612 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1613 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001614
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001615 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001616
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001617log-send-hostname [<string>]
1618 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1619 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1620 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1621 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1622 the logs.
1623
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001624log-tag <string>
1625 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1626 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1627 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001628 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001629
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001630lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001631 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1632 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1633 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1634 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1635 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1636 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001637 used multiple times.
1638
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001639lua-load-per-thread <file>
1640 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1641 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1642 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1643 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1644 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1645 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1646 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1647 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1648 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1649 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1650 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1651 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1652 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1653 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1654 times.
1655
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001656lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1657 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1658 variable.
1659 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1660 to "path".
1661
1662 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1663 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1664 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1665 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1666 will be checked earlier.
1667
1668 As an example by specifying the following path:
1669
1670 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1671 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1672
1673 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1674 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1675 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1676 paths if that does not exist either.
1677
1678 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1679 documentation.
1680
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001681master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001682 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1683 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1684 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001685 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001686 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1687 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001688 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1689 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1690 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1691 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1692 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001693
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001694 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001695
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001696mworker-max-reloads <number>
1697 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001698 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001699 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1700 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1701 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1702
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001703nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001704 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1705 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1706 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001707 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1708 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001709 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1710 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1711 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001712
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001713nbthread <number>
1714 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001715 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001716 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1717 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1718 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1719 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001720 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1721 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1722 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1723 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1724 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1725 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1726 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001727
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001728numa-cpu-mapping
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001729 By default, if running on Linux, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001730 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1731 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1732 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1733 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1734 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1735 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1736 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1737 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1738
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001739pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001740 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1741 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1742 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1743 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001744
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001745pp2-never-send-local
1746 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1747 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1748 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1749 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1750 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1751 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1752 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1753 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1754 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1755 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1756 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1757
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001758presetenv <name> <value>
1759 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1760 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1761 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1762 and "unsetenv".
1763
1764resetenv [<name> ...]
1765 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1766 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1767 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1768 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1769 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1770 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1771 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1772 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1773
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001774stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001775 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1776 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1777 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1778 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1779 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1780 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001781 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001782 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1783 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1784 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1785 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001786
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001787server-state-base <directory>
1788 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001789 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1790 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001791
1792server-state-file <file>
1793 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1794 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1795 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1796 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1797 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1798 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1799 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1800 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001801 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1802 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001803
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001804set-dumpable
1805 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1806 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1807 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1808 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1809 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1810 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1811 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1812 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1813 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1814 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1815 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1816 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1817 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1818 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1819 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1820 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1821 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
1822 leaves a core where expected when dying.
1823
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001824set-var <var-name> <expr>
1825 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1826 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1827 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1828 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1829 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1830 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1831 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1832 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1833 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1834
1835 Example:
1836 global
1837 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1838 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1839 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1840
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001841setenv <name> <value>
1842 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1843 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1844 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1845 and "unsetenv".
1846
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001847ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1848 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1849 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001850 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001851 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001852 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1853 information and recommendations see e.g.
1854 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1855 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1856 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1857 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001858
1859ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1860 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1861 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1862 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1863 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1864 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001865 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1866 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1867 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001868 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001869
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001870ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1871 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1872 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1873 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1874 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1875 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1876
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001877ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1878 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1879 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1880 keyword to see available options.
1881
1882 Example:
1883 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001884 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001885
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001886ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1887 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1888 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001889 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001890 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001891 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1892 information and recommendations see e.g.
1893 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1894 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1895 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1896 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1897 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001898
1899ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1900 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1901 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1902 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1903 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1904 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001905 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1906 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1907 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1908 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001909
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001910ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1911 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1912 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1913 keyword to see available options.
1914
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001915ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1916 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1917 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1918 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001919 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001920 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001921 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1922 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1923 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1924 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001925 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1926 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1927 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1928
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001929ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1930 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1931 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001932 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001933 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001934 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1935
1936 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001937
1938 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1939 and won't try to remove them.
1940
1941 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1942
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001943ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001944 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001945 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
1946 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
1947 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001948
1949 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1950 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1951 optimize the startup time.
1952
1953 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1954 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1955 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1956
1957 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001958 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001959
1960 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001961 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
1962 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001963
1964 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1965 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1966 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1967 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1968 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001969 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001970
1971 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001972 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001973 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1974 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1975 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1976 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1977 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001978 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001979
1980 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1981
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001982 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001983 a cert bundle.
1984
1985 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1986 separately in several "crt".
1987
1988 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1989 since files are loading separately.
1990
1991 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1992 required to commit them.
1993
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001994 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001995 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001996
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001997 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
1998 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
1999 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002000
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002001 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2002 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2003 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002004
2005 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002006 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2007 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002008
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002009 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2010 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2011
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002012 The default behavior is "all".
2013
2014 Example:
2015 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2016 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2017 ssl-load-extra-files none
2018
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002019 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2020 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002021
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002022ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2023 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2024 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2025 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2026
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002027ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002028 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002029 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2030 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2031 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2032 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2033 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2034 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002035 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002036
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002037stats maxconn <connections>
2038 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2039 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2040
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002041stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2042 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2043 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2044 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002045 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002046 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002047
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002048 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2049 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2050 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002051
2052stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2053 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2054 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002055 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002056
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002057strict-limits
2058 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
2059 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2060 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2061 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2062 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002063
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002064uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002065 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002066 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2067 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2068 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2069
2070ulimit-n <number>
2071 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2072 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
2073 option.
2074
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002075unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2076 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2077
2078 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2079 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2080 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2081 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2082 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002083 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002084 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2085 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2086 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2087 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2088
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002089unsetenv [<name> ...]
2090 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2091 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2092 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2093 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2094 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2095 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2096 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2097
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002098user <user name>
2099 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2100 See also "uid" and "group".
2101
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002102node <name>
2103 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2104
2105 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2106 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2107 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2108 traffic.
2109
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002110wurfl-cache-size <size>
2111 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2112 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
2113 - "0" : no cache is used.
2114 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002115
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002116 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
2117 with USE_WURFL=1.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002118
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002119wurfl-data-file <file path>
2120 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2121 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2122
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002123 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002124 with USE_WURFL=1.
2125
2126wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2127 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2128 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2129 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2130
2131 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2132
2133 Valid WURFL properties are:
2134 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2135
2136 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2137 device.
2138
2139 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2140 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2141
2142 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2143 particular web request.
2144
2145 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2146 used Libwurfl API version.
2147
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002148 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2149 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2150
2151 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2152 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2153
2154 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2155
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002156 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002157 with USE_WURFL=1.
2158
2159wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2160 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2161 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2162
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002163 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002164 with USE_WURFL=1.
2165
2166wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2167 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2168 thus before the chroot.
2169
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002170 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002171 with USE_WURFL=1.
2172
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021733.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002174-----------------------
2175
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002176busy-polling
2177 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2178 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2179 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2180 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2181 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2182 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2183 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2184 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2185 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2186 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2187 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2188 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2189 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2190 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2191 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2192 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2193 "poll" pollers.
2194
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002195 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2196 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2197 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2198
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002199max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002200 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002201 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2202 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2203 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2204 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2205 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2206 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2207 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2208
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002209maxcompcpuusage <number>
2210 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2211 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2212 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2213 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2214 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2215 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2216 and from introducing high latencies.
2217
2218maxcomprate <number>
2219 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
2220 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
2221 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2222 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2223 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
2224 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
2225 default value.
2226
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002227maxconn <number>
2228 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2229 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2230 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002231 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2232 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2233 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2234 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002235 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2236 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2237 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2238 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2239 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2240 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002241
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002242maxconnrate <number>
2243 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2244 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2245 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2246 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2247 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2248 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2249 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2250 fairness.
2251
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002252maxpipes <number>
2253 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2254 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2255 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2256 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2257 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2258 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2259
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002260maxsessrate <number>
2261 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2262 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2263 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2264 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2265 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2266 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2267 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2268 fairness.
2269
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002270maxsslconn <number>
2271 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2272 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2273 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2274 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2275 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2276 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2277 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002278 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2279 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2280 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2281 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002282 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002283 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2284 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002285
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002286maxsslrate <number>
2287 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2288 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2289 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2290 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2291 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2292 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2293 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2294 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2295 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2296 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2297
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002298maxzlibmem <number>
2299 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2300 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2301 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002302 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2303 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2304 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2305
Willy Tarreau85dd5212022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002306no-memory-trimming
2307 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2308 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2309 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2310 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2311 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2312 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2313 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2314 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2315 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2316 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2317 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2318 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2319 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2320 not suffer from such a problem.
2321
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002322noepoll
2323 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2324 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002325 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002326
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002327noevports
2328 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2329 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2330 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2331 also "nopoll".
2332
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002333nogetaddrinfo
2334 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2335 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2336
2337nokqueue
2338 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2339 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2340 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2341
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002342nopoll
2343 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2344 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002345 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002346 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2347 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002348
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002349noreuseport
2350 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2351 command line argument "-dR".
2352
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002353nosplice
2354 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002355 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002356 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002357 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002358 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2359 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2360 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2361 "option splice-response".
2362
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002363profiling.memory { on | off }
2364 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2365 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2366 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2367 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2368 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2369 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2370 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2371 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2372 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2373
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002374profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2375 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2376 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2377 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2378 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002379 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002380 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2381 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2382 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2383 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2384
2385 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2386 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2387 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2388 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2389 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002390 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2391 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2392 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2393 CLI.
2394
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002395spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002396 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2397 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2398 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2399 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2400 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2401 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002402
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002403ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002404 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002405 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002406 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002407 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002408 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2409 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2410 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002411 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2412 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002413 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2414 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2415 openssl configuration file uses:
2416 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2417
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002418ssl-mode-async
2419 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002420 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002421 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2422 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002423 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002424 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002425 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002426
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002427tune.buffers.limit <number>
2428 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2429 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2430 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2431 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2432 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002433 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002434 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2435 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2436 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2437 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2438 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2439 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2440 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2441 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002442 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002443
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002444tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2445 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2446 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2447 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002448 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002449
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002450tune.bufsize <number>
2451 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2452 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2453 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2454 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2455 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2456 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2457 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002458 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2459 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002460 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002461 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002462 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002463 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2464 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002465
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002466tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2467 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002468
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002469tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2470 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2471 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2472 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2473 this value. The default value is 1.
2474
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002475tune.fail-alloc
2476 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2477 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2478 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2479 gracefully.
2480
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002481tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2482 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2483 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2484 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2485 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2486 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2487
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002488tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2489 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2490 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2491 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2492 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2493 change it.
2494
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002495tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2496 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002497 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002498 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002499 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2500 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2501 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2502 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2503 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2504
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002505tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2506 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2507 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2508 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2509 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2510 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002511 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002512 recommended not to change this value.
2513
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002514tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002515 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002516 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002517 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002518 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2519 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2520 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2521 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2522
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002523tune.http.cookielen <number>
2524 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2525 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2526 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2527 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2528 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2529 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2530 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2531 to change this value.
2532
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002533tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002534 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2535 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002536 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002537 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002538 configuration directives too.
2539 The default value is 1024.
2540
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002541tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2542 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2543 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2544 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2545 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2546 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2547 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002548 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2549 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2550 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002551
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002552tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2553 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2554 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2555 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2556 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2557 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2558 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002559 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2560 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2561 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2562 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2563 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002564
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002565tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002566 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002567 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2568 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2569 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2570 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002571 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002572 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002573 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002574 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2575
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002576tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2577 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2578 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2579 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2580 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2581 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2582 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2583 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2584 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2585 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2586
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002587tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2588 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002589 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002590 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2591 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002592 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002593 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2594 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2595
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002596tune.lua.maxmem
2597 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2598 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2599 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2600 memory.
2601
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002602tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2603 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002604 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2605 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002606 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002607
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002608tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2609 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2610 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2611 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002612 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002613
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002614tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2615 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2616 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2617 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2618 check servers.
2619
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002620tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002621 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2622 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002623 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2624 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2625 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2626 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2627 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2628 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2629 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2630 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2631 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002632
2633tune.maxpollevents <number>
2634 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2635 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2636 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2637 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2638 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2639
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002640tune.maxrewrite <number>
2641 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2642 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2643 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2644 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2645 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2646 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2647 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2648 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2649 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2650 bufsize.
2651
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002652tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2653 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2654 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2655 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2656 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2657 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2658 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2659 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2660 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2661 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002662 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2663 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002664 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2665 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2666 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2667 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2668 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2669 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2670 setting this parameter to 0.
2671
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002672tune.pipesize <number>
2673 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2674 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2675 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2676 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2677 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2678 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2679
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002680tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2681 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002682 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002683 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2684 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2685 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2686 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002687 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002688
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002689tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2690 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002691 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002692 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2693 default is 20.
2694
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002695tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2696tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2697 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2698 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2699 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002700 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002701 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002702 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2703 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2704
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002705tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002706 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002707 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2708 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2709 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2710 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2711
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002712tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002713 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002714 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2715 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2716 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2717 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2718 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2719 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2720 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002721
2722tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2723 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002724 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002725 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2726 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2727 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2728 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2729 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2730 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2731 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002732
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002733tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2734tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2735 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2736 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2737 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002738 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002739 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002740 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2741 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2742 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2743 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002744 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002745
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002746tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002747 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002748 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2749 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2750 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2751 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2752 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2753 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2754 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2755 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2756 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2757 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2758 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002759
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002760tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2761 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
2762 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
2763 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
2764 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2765
2766tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2767 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2768 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2769 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2770 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2771 this maximum value. Only 1024 or higher values are allowed. Higher values
2772 will increase the CPU load, and values greater than 1024 bits are not
2773 supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not used if static
2774 Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly in the certificate
2775 file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
2776 If there is neither a default-dh-param nor a ssl-dh-param-file defined, and
2777 if the server's PEM file of a given frontend does not specify its own DH
2778 parameters, then DHE ciphers will be unavailable for this frontend.
2779
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002780tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002781 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002782 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2783 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2784 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2785 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2786 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2787
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002788tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2789 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2790 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2791 performances. This is disabled by default.
2792
2793 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2794 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2795
2796 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2797
2798 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2799
2800 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2801
2802 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2803 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2804 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2805
2806 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2807 converted.
2808
2809 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2810 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2811 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2812 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2813 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2814 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2815 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002816 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2817 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002818
2819 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2820
2821 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2822 only need this line:
2823
2824 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2825
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002826tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2827 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002828 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002829 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2830 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2831 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2832 being used for too long.
2833
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002834tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2835 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2836 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2837 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2838 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2839 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2840 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2841 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2842 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2843 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2844 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002845 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002846 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002847
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002848tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2849 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2850 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2851 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2852 1000 entries.
2853
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002854tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002855tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002856tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2857tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2858tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002859 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2860 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2861 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2862 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2863 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2864 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2865 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2866 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002867
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002868 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2869 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2870 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2871 all available space is consumed.
2872 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2873 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2874 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002875
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002876tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2877 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002878 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002879 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002880 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002881 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2882
2883tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2884 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2885 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002886 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2887 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002888
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028893.3. Debugging
2890--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002891
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002892quiet
2893 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2894 line argument "-q".
2895
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002896zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002897 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002898 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2899 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2900 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2901 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2902 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2903
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002904
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010029053.4. Userlists
2906--------------
2907It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2908http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2909it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2910
2911userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002912 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002913 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2914
2915group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002916 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002917 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2918 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2919
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002920user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2921 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002922 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2923 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002924 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2925 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2926 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2927 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002928
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002929 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2930 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2931 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2932 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2933 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2934 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2935 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002936 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002937 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002938
2939 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002940 userlist L1
2941 group G1 users tiger,scott
2942 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002943
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002944 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2945 user scott insecure-password elgato
2946 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002947
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002948 userlist L2
2949 group G1
2950 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002951
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002952 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2953 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2954 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002955
2956 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002957
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002958
29593.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002960----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002961It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002962several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002963instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2964values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2965automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2966In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2967using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2968tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2969reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2970Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2971that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2972each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002973
2974peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002975 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002976 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2977
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002978bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2979 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2980 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2981
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002982disabled
2983 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2984 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2985 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2986
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002987default-bind [param*]
2988 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2989
2990default-server [param*]
2991 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2992
2993 Arguments:
2994 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2995 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02002996 section dedicated to it. In a peers section, the transport
2997 parameters of a "default-server" line are supported. Please refer
2998 to section 5 for more details, and the "server" keyword below in
2999 this section for some of the restrictions.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003000
3001 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3002
Emeric Brun7214dcf2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02003003enabled
3004 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3005 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003006
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003007log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003008 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3009 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3010 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3011 more details.
3012
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003013peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003014 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3015 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003016 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003017 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003018 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
3019 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
3020 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003021
3022 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
3023 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3024
3025 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003026 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3027 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3028 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003029
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003030 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3031 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003032
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003033 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3034 "server" keyword explanation below).
3035
3036server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003037 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003038 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph that are
3039 related to transport settings. If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port>
3040 parameters must not be present; these parameters must be provided on a "bind"
3041 line (see "bind" keyword of this "peers" section).
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003042
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003043 A number of "server" parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections. Peers by
3044 nature do not support dynamic host name resolution nor health checks, hence
3045 parameters like "init_addr", "resolvers", "check", "agent-check", or "track"
3046 are not supported. Similarly, there is no load balancing nor stickiness, thus
3047 parameters such as "weight" or "cookie" have no effect.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003048
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003049 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003050 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003051 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003052 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3053 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3054 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003055
3056 backend mybackend
3057 mode tcp
3058 balance roundrobin
3059 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3060 stick on src
3061
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003062 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3063 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003064
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003065 Example:
3066 peers mypeers
Emeric Brun6ca8ba42022-05-30 18:13:35 +02003067 bind 192.168.0.1:1024 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3068 default-server ssl verify none
3069 server haproxy1 #local peer
3070 server haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3071 server haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003072
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003073
3074table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3075 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3076
3077 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3078 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003079 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003080 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3081 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3082 "stick-table" keyword).
3083
3084 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3085 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3086 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3087 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3088 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3089 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3090 of the stick-table name as follows:
3091
3092 peers mypeers
3093 peer A ...
3094 peer B ...
3095 table t1 ...
3096
3097 frontend fe1
3098 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3099
3100 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3101 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3102
3103 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3104 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3105 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3106 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3107 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3108 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3109 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3110
3111 peers mypeers
3112 peer A ...
3113 peer B ...
3114 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3115
3116 backend t1
3117 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3118
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003119 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003120 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3121 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3122
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090031233.6. Mailers
3124------------
3125It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3126If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3127in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3128
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003129mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003130 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3131 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3132
3133mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3134 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3135
3136 Example:
3137 mailers mymailers
3138 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3139 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3140
3141 backend mybackend
3142 mode tcp
3143 balance roundrobin
3144
3145 email-alert mailers mymailers
3146 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3147 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3148
3149 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3150 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3151
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003152timeout mail <time>
3153 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3154 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3155 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3156 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3157
3158 Example:
3159 mailers mymailers
3160 timeout mail 20s
3161 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003162
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020031633.7. Programs
3164-------------
3165In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3166master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3167managed the same way as the workers.
3168
3169During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3170sequence as a worker:
3171
3172 - the master is re-executed
3173 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3174 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3175 instance of the program
3176
3177During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3178
3179program <name>
3180 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3181 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3182 the management guide).
3183
3184command <command> [arguments*]
3185 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3186 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3187 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3188 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3189
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003190user <user name>
3191 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3192 See also "group".
3193
3194group <group name>
3195 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3196 See also "user".
3197
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003198option start-on-reload
3199no option start-on-reload
3200 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3201 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3202 program section.
3203
3204
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010032053.8. HTTP-errors
3206----------------
3207
3208It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3209imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3210several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3211
3212http-errors <name>
3213 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3214 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3215
3216errorfile <code> <file>
3217 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3218
3219 Arguments :
3220 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003221 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003222 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003223
3224 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3225 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3226 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3227 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3228 before any chroot is performed.
3229
3230 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3231
3232 Example:
3233 http-errors website-1
3234 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3235 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3236 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3237
3238 http-errors website-2
3239 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3240 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3241 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3242
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020032433.9. Rings
3244----------
3245
3246It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3247servers or traces.
3248
3249ring <ringname>
3250 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3251
3252description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003253 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003254 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3255
3256format <format>
3257 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3258
3259 Arguments:
3260 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3261 one of the following :
3262
3263 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3264 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3265 designed to be used with a local log server.
3266
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003267 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3268 field is stripped. This is the default.
3269 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3270 rfc3164.
3271
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003272 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3273 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3274 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3275 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3276 is the default.
3277
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003278 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003279 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3280
3281 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3282 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3283
3284 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3285 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3286 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3287 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3288 logger consumes.
3289
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003290 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3291 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3292 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3293 with a local log server.
3294
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003295 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3296 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3297 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3298 used with a local log server.
3299
3300maxlen <length>
3301 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3302 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3303 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3304
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003305server <name> <address> [param*]
3306 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3307 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3308 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3309 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3310 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3311 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3312 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3313 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3314 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003315 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3316 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003317
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003318size <size>
3319 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3320 set to BUFSIZE.
3321
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003322timeout connect <timeout>
3323 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3324
3325 Arguments :
3326 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3327 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3328 as explained at the top of this document.
3329
3330timeout server <timeout>
3331 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3332
3333 Arguments :
3334 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3335 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3336 as explained at the top of this document.
3337
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003338 Example:
3339 global
3340 log ring@myring local7
3341
3342 ring myring
3343 description "My local buffer"
3344 format rfc3164
3345 maxlen 1200
3346 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003347 timeout connect 5s
3348 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003349 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003350
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020033513.10. Log forwarding
3352-------------------
3353
3354It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003355HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003356
3357log-forward <name>
3358 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3359
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003360backlog <conns>
3361 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3362 on connections accept.
3363
3364bind <addr> [param*]
3365 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003366 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3367 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3368 syslog protocol over TCP.
3369 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003370 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3371
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003372dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003373 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3374 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3375 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3376 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003377 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003378
3379log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003380log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003381 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3382 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3383 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003384 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003385 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3386 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3387 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003388 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003389
3390 Example:
3391 global
3392 log stderr format iso local7
3393
3394 ring myring
3395 description "My local buffer"
3396 format rfc5424
3397 maxlen 1200
3398 size 32764
3399 timeout connect 5s
3400 timeout server 10s
3401 # syslog tcp server
3402 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3403
3404 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003405 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3406 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003407 # all messages on stderr
3408 log global
3409 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3410 log ring@myring local0
3411 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3412 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3413 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3414 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3415 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003416
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003417maxconn <conns>
3418 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3419 10 is the default.
3420
3421timeout client <timeout>
3422 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3423
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020034244. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003425----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003426
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003427Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003428 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3429 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3430 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3431 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003432
3433A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3434connections.
3435
3436A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3437to forward incoming connections.
3438
3439A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3440parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3441
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003442A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3443ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3444sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3445the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3446explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3447from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3448"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3449for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3450to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3451optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3452are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3453any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3454names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3455that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3456duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3457names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3458
3459Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3460settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3461of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3462profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3463timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3464
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003465All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3466'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3467case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3468
3469Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3470logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3471proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3472However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3473name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3474
3475Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3476and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003477bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003478protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3479modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3480arbitrary criteria.
3481
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003482In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3483a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003484the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003485
3486 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3487 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3488 between responses and new requests.
3489
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003490 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3491 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3492 client-facing connection remains open.
3493
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003494 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3495 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003496
3497The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3498frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3499following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003500weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003501
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003502 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003503
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003504 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3505 ----+-----+-----+----
3506 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3507 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003508 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3509 ----+-----+-----+----
3510 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003511
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003512It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003513only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3514within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003515as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003516content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003517and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3518possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003519
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003520There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003521first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003522processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003523second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003524protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3525is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3526new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003527to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003528process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3529already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3530HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3531evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3532one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3533
3534There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3535performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3536tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3537preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3538analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3539HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3540header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3541mitigate this drawback.
3542
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003543There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003544method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3545set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3546in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3547is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3548to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3549above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3550to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3551"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3552frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3553frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3554as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3555upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3556on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3557the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3558upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3559frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3560remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003561
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035624.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3563--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003564
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003565The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3566limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3567they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3568limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003569marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003570option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003571and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3572with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3573specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003574
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003575
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003576 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3577------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3578acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003579backlog X X X -
3580balance X - X X
3581bind - X X -
3582bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003583capture cookie - X X -
3584capture request header - X X -
3585capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003586clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3587clitcpka-idle X X X -
3588clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003589compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003590cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003591declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003592default-server X - X X
3593default_backend X X X -
3594description - X X X
3595disabled X X X X
3596dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003597email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003598email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003599email-alert mailers X X X X
3600email-alert myhostname X X X X
3601email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003602enabled X X X X
3603errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003604errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003605errorloc X X X X
3606errorloc302 X X X X
3607-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3608errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003609force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003610filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003611fullconn X - X X
3612grace X X X X
3613hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003614http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003615http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003616http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003617http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003618http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003619http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003620http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003621http-check set-var X - X X
3622http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003623http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003624http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003625http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003626http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003627http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003628id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003629ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003630load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003631log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003632log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003633log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003634log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003635max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003636maxconn X X X -
3637mode X X X X
3638monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003639monitor-uri X X X -
3640option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3641option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3642option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3643option allbackups (*) X - X X
3644option checkcache (*) X - X X
3645option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3646option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003647option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003648option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3649option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003650-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3651option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003652option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3653option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003654option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003655option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003656option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003657option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003658option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet79507152022-05-16 11:43:10 +02003659option http-restrict-req-hdr-names X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003660option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3661option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3662option httpchk X - X X
3663option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003664option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003665option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003666option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003667option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003668option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003669option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3670option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3671option logasap (*) X X X -
3672option mysql-check X - X X
3673option nolinger (*) X X X X
3674option originalto X X X X
3675option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003676option pgsql-check X - X X
3677option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003678option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003679option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003680option smtpchk X - X X
3681option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3682option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3683option splice-request (*) X X X X
3684option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003685option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003686option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3687option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3688-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003689option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003690option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3691option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3692option tcpka X X X X
3693option tcplog X X X X
3694option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchy4711a892022-01-05 22:53:24 +01003695option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003696external-check command X - X X
3697external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003698persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3699rate-limit sessions X X X -
3700redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003701-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003702retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003703retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003704server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003705server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003706server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003707source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003708srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3709srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3710srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003711stats admin - X X X
3712stats auth X X X X
3713stats enable X X X X
3714stats hide-version X X X X
3715stats http-request - X X X
3716stats realm X X X X
3717stats refresh X X X X
3718stats scope X X X X
3719stats show-desc X X X X
3720stats show-legends X X X X
3721stats show-node X X X X
3722stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003723-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3724stick match - - X X
3725stick on - - X X
3726stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003727stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003728stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003729tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003730tcp-check connect X - X X
3731tcp-check expect X - X X
3732tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003733tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003734tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003735tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003736tcp-check set-var X - X X
3737tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003738tcp-request connection - X X -
3739tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003740tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003741tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003742tcp-response content - - X X
3743tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003744timeout check X - X X
3745timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003746timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003747timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003748timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3749timeout http-request X X X X
3750timeout queue X - X X
3751timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003752timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003753timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003754timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003755transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003756unique-id-format X X X -
3757unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003758use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003759use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003760use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003761------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3762 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003763
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003764
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037654.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3766---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003767
3768This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3769
3770
3771acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3772 Declare or complete an access list.
3773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3774 no | yes | yes | yes
3775 Example:
3776 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3777 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3778 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3779
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003780 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003781
3782
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003783backlog <conns>
3784 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3786 yes | yes | yes | no
3787 Arguments :
3788 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3789 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003790 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003791
3792 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3793 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3794 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3795 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3796 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3797 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3798 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3799 backlog parameter.
3800
3801 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3802 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3803 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3804
3805 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3806
3807
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003808balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003809balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003810 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3812 yes | no | yes | yes
3813 Arguments :
3814 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3815 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3816 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3817 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3818
3819 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3820 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3821 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3822 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003823 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003824 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003825 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3826 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3827 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3828 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3829 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3830 it, so that you don't worry.
3831
3832 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3833 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3834 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3835 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3836 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3837 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3838 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3839 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003840
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003841 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3842 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3843 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3844 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3845 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3846 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3847 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003848 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3849 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3850 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003851
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003852 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003853 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003854 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3855 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003856 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003857 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3858 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3859 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3860 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3861 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003862 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3863 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3864 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3865 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3866 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3867 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003868
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003869 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3870 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3871 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3872 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3873 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3874 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3875 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3876 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003877 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003878 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003879 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3880 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3881 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003882
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003883 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3884 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3885 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3886 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3887 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3888 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3889 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3890 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3891 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3892 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3893 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3894 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003895
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003896 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003897 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3898 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3899 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3900 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3901 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3902 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3903 URIs start with a leading "/".
3904
3905 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3906 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3907 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3908 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3909
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003910 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3911 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3912 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3913 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3914
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003915 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003916 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3917
3918 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003919 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3920 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003921 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3922 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3923 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3924 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003925 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003926 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3927 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003928
3929 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3930 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3931 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3932 server will receive the request.
3933
3934 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3935 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3936 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3937 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3938 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003939 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3940 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3941 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003942
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003943 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3944 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3945 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3946 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3947 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003948
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003949 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003950 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3951 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3952 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3953
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003954 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3955 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3956 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3957
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003958 random
3959 random(<draws>)
3960 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003961 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3962 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3963 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3964 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003965 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3966 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3967 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3968 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3969 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3970 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3971 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3972 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3973 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3974 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3975 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3976 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3977 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3978 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3979 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3980 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3981 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3982 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3983 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3984 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003985
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003986 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003987 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003988 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3989 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +01003990 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003991 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3992 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3993 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003994 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003995 used instead.
3996
3997 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3998 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3999 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004000 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004001
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004002 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4003 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4004 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
4005
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004006 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004007 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4008 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004009
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004010 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4011 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4012 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004013
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004014 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004015 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004016 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4017 NTLM relies on.
4018
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004019 Examples :
4020 balance roundrobin
4021 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004022 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004023 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4024 balance hdr(host)
4025 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004026
4027 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4028 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4029
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004030 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004031 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4032 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4033 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004034 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004035
4036 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4037 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4038 defaults to 16 kB.
4039
4040 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4041 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4042
4043 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4044 Round Robin.
4045
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004046 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004047 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4048 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4049 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4050
4051 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4052
4053 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004054 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004055 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4056 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4057 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004058
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004059 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004060
4061
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004062bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4063bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004064 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4066 no | yes | yes | no
4067 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004068 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4069 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4070 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4071 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004072 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004073 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4074 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4075 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4076 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4077 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4078 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004079 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004080 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4081 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004082 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004083 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4084 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004085 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004086 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4087 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004088 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004089 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
4090 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
4091 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
4092 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
4093 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
4094 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
4095 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004096 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4097 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4098 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004099 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4100 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4101 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4102 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004103 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4104 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4105 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004106
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004107 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4108 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004109 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4110 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4111 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004112 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4113 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4114 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4115 the range.
4116
4117 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4118 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4119 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4120 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4121 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4122 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4123 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004124 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004125 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004126
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004127 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004128 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004129 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4130 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4131 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4132 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4133 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4134 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4135
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004136 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4137 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4138 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4139 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004140
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004141 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4142 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4143 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4144 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4145 in a frontend.
4146
4147 Example :
4148 listen http_proxy
4149 bind :80,:443
4150 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004151 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004152
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004153 listen http_https_proxy
4154 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004155 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004156
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004157 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4158 bind ipv6@:80
4159 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4160 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4161
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004162 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004163 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004164
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004165 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4166 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4167 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4168 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4169 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4170
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004171 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004172 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004173
4174
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004175bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004176 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
4177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4178 yes | yes | yes | yes
4179 Arguments :
4180 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
4181 may be used to override a default value.
4182
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004183 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004184 option may be combined with other numbers.
4185
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004186 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004187 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
4188 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
4189 missing from all processes.
4190
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004191 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004192 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004193 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
4194 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
4195 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
4196 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
4197 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02004198 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004199
4200 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
4201 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
4202 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
4203 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
4204 and 'even' instances.
4205
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004206 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
4207 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
4208 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
4209 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004210
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004211 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
4212 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
4213
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02004214 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
4215 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
4216 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
4217
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004218 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
4219 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
4220
4221 Example :
4222 listen app_ip1
4223 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004224 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004225
4226 listen app_ip2
4227 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004228 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004229
4230 listen management
4231 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004232 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004233
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004234 listen management
4235 bind 10.0.0.4:80
4236 bind-process 1-4
4237
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004238 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004239
4240
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004241capture cookie <name> len <length>
4242 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4244 no | yes | yes | no
4245 Arguments :
4246 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4247 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4248 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4249 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004250 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004251
4252 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4253 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4254 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4255 right if it exceeds <length>.
4256
4257 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4258 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4259 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4260 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4261
4262 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4263 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4264 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4265
4266 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4267 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4268 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004269 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4270 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4271 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004272
4273 Example:
4274 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4275
4276 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004277 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004278
4279
4280capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004281 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4283 no | yes | yes | no
4284 Arguments :
4285 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004286 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004287 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4288 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4289 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4290
4291 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4292 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4293 it exceeds <length>.
4294
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004295 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004296 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4297 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004298 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4299 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4300 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4301 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004302 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004303 environments to find where the request came from.
4304
4305 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4306 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4307 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4308 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004309
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004310 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4311 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4312 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4313 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4314 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004315
4316 Example:
4317 capture request header Host len 15
4318 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004319 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004320
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004321 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004322 about logging.
4323
4324
4325capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004326 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4328 no | yes | yes | no
4329 Arguments :
4330 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004331 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004332 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4333 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4334 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4335
4336 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4337 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4338 it exceeds <length>.
4339
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004340 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004341 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4342 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4343 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004344 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4345 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4346 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4347 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004348
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004349 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4350 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4351 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4352 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4353 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004354
4355 Example:
4356 capture response header Content-length len 9
4357 capture response header Location len 15
4358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004359 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004360 about logging.
4361
4362
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004363clitcpka-cnt <count>
4364 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4365 the connection on the client side.
4366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4367 yes | yes | yes | no
4368 Arguments :
4369 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4370
4371 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4372 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004373 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4374 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004375
4376 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4377
4378
4379clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4380 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4381 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4382 client side.
4383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4384 yes | yes | yes | no
4385 Arguments :
4386 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4387 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4388 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4389 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4390
4391 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4392 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004393 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4394 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004395
4396 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4397
4398
4399clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4400 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4402 yes | yes | yes | no
4403 Arguments :
4404 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4405 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4406 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4407 document.
4408
4409 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4410 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004411 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4412 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004413
4414 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4415
4416
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004417compression algo <algorithm> ...
4418compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004419compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004420 Enable HTTP compression.
4421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4422 yes | yes | yes | yes
4423 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004424 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4425 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004426 offload makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004427
4428 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004429 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4430 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4431 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004432
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004433 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004434 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004435
4436 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4437 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4438 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4439 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4440 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004441 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004442
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004443 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4444 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4445 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4446 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4447 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4448 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4449 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004450 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004451
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004452 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004453 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004454 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004455 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004456 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004457 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004458 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004459
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004460 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004461 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4462 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004463 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4464 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004465 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004466 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004467 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4468 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004469 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004470 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4471 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004472
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004473 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004474 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4475 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004476 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004477 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004478 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4479 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4480 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4481 "multipart"
4482 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4483 header
4484 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4485 and later
4486 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4487 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004488 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004489
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004490 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004491
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004492 Examples :
4493 compression algo gzip
4494 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004495
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004496
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004497cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004498 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4499 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004500 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004501 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4502 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4503 yes | no | yes | yes
4504 Arguments :
4505 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4506 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4507 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4508 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4509 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4510 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004511 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004512 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4513 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4514
4515 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004516 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004517 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4518 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4519 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4520 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004521 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4522 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004523 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004524 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4525 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004526
4527 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004528 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004529
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004530 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004531 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004532 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004533 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004534 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4535 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4536 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4537 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4538 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4539 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4540 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004541
4542 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4543 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4544 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4545 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4546 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4547 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4548 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4549 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4550 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004551 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004552 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4553 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4554 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004555
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004556 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4557 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4558 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004559 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4560 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4561 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4562 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004563 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4564 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4565 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004566
4567 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4568 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4569 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4570 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4571 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4572 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4573 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4574 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4575 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4576
4577 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4578 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4579 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4580 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4581 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4582 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4583 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4584 persistence cookie in the cache.
4585 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4586
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004587 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4588 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004589 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004590 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4591 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004592 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004593 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4594 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4595 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4596 they logout.
4597
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004598 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004599 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4600 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4601 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4602
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004603 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004604 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4605 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4606 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4607 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4608 this attribute.
4609
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004610 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004611 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004612 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4613 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4614 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4615 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4616 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4617 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004618
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004619 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4620 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4621 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4622 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4623 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4624 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4625 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4626 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004627 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004628 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4629 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4630 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4631 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4632 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4633 the site.
4634
4635 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4636 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4637 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4638 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4639 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4640 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4641 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4642 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4643 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4644 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4645 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4646 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4647 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004648 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004649 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4650 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4651
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004652 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4653 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4654 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4655 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4656 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4657 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4658
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004659 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004660 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4661 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4662 repeated.
4663
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004664 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4665 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4666 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4667 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004668
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004669 Examples :
4670 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4671 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4672 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004673 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004674
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004675 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004676
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004677
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004678declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4679 Declares a capture slot.
4680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4681 no | yes | yes | no
4682 Arguments:
4683 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4684
4685 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4686 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4687 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4688 for use in the response.
4689
4690 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004691 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004692 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4693
4694
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004695default-server [param*]
4696 Change default options for a server in a backend
4697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4698 yes | no | yes | yes
4699 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004700 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4701 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4702 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4703 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004704
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004705 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004706 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4707
4708 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004709
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004710
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004711default_backend <backend>
4712 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4714 yes | yes | yes | no
4715 Arguments :
4716 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4717
4718 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4719 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4720 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4721 will catch all undetermined requests.
4722
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004723 Example :
4724
4725 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4726 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4727 default_backend dynamic
4728
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004729 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004730
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004731
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004732description <string>
4733 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4735 no | yes | yes | yes
4736 Arguments : string
4737
4738 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4739 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4740 it describes.
4741 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4742
4743
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004744disabled
4745 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4747 yes | yes | yes | yes
4748 Arguments : none
4749
4750 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4751 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4752 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4753 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4754 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4755 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4756 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4757
4758 See also : "enabled"
4759
4760
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004761dispatch <address>:<port>
4762 Set a default server address
4763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4764 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004765 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004766
4767 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4768 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4769 during start-up.
4770
4771 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4772 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4773 possible with normal servers.
4774
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004775 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004776 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4777 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4778 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4779 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4780
4781 See also : "server"
4782
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004783
4784dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4785 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4787 yes | no | yes | yes
4788 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4789
4790 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004791 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004792 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4793 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004794 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004795 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004796
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004797enabled
4798 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4800 yes | yes | yes | yes
4801 Arguments : none
4802
4803 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4804 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4805
4806 See also : "disabled"
4807
4808
4809errorfile <code> <file>
4810 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4812 yes | yes | yes | yes
4813 Arguments :
4814 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004815 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004816 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004817
4818 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004819 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004820 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004821 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4822 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004823
4824 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4825 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4826 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4827
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004828 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4829
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004830 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4831 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4832 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4833 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4834 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4835 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4836 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4837 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4838 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004839
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004840 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4841 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4842 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004843 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004844 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4845
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004846 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004847
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004848 Example :
4849 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004850 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004851 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4852 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4853
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004854
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004855errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4856 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4857 section.
4858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4859 yes | yes | yes | yes
4860 Arguments :
4861 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4862
4863 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004864 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004865 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4866 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004867
4868 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4869 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4870 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4871 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4872 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004873 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004874 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4875
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004876 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4877 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004878
4879 Example :
4880 errorfiles generic
4881 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4882
4883
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004884errorloc <code> <url>
4885errorloc302 <code> <url>
4886 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4888 yes | yes | yes | yes
4889 Arguments :
4890 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004891 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004892 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004893
4894 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4895 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4896 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4897 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004898 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004899
4900 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4901 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4902 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4903
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004904 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4905
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004906 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4907 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4908 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4909 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004910 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004911 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4912 request.
4913
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004914 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004915
4916
4917errorloc303 <code> <url>
4918 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4920 yes | yes | yes | yes
4921 Arguments :
4922 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004923 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004924 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004925
4926 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4927 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4928 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4929 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004930 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004931
4932 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4933 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4934 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4935
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004936 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4937
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004938 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4939 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4940 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4941 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004942 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004943
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004944 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004945
4946
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004947email-alert from <emailaddr>
4948 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004949 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004950 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4951 yes | yes | yes | yes
4952
4953 Arguments :
4954
4955 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4956
4957 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4958 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4959
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004960 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004961 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4962 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004963
4964
4965email-alert level <level>
4966 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4967 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4968 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4969 yes | yes | yes | yes
4970
4971 Arguments :
4972
4973 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4974 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4975 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4976
4977 By default level is alert
4978
4979 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4980 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4981 for the proxy.
4982
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004983 Alerts are sent when :
4984
4985 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4986 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4987 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4988 is notice or lower
4989 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4990 and a health check status update occurs
4991
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004992 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4993 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004994 section 3.6 about mailers.
4995
4996
4997email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4998 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4999 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5000 yes | yes | yes | yes
5001
5002 Arguments :
5003
5004 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
5005
5006 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
5007 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5008
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005009 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
5010 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005011
5012
5013email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5014 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5015 mailers.
5016 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5017 yes | yes | yes | yes
5018
5019 Arguments :
5020
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005021 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005022
5023 By default the systems hostname is used.
5024
5025 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5026 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5027 for the proxy.
5028
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005029 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5030 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005031
5032
5033email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005034 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005035 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5036 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5037 yes | yes | yes | yes
5038
5039 Arguments :
5040
5041 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5042
5043 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5044 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5045
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005046 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005047 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5048
5049
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005050force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5051 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5052 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005053 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005054
5055 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5056 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5057 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5058 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5059 marked down for maintenance operations.
5060
5061 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5062 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5063 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5064 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5065 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5066 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5067 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5068 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5069 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5070
5071 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5072 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5073 is used.
5074
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005075 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005076 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005077
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005078
5079filter <name> [param*]
5080 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5082 no | yes | yes | yes
5083 Arguments :
5084 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5085 referenced in section 9.
5086
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005087 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005088 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005089 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5090 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005091
5092 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5093 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5094
5095 Example:
5096 listen
5097 bind *:80
5098
5099 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5100 filter compression
5101 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5102
5103 compression algo gzip
5104 compression offload
5105
5106 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5107
5108 See also : section 9.
5109
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005110
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005111fullconn <conns>
5112 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5114 yes | no | yes | yes
5115 Arguments :
5116 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5117 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5118
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005119 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005120 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005121 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005122 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5123 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5124 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5125 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5126 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005127 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005128
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005129 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005130 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005131 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5132 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5133 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005134
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005135 Example :
5136 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5137 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5138 # connections.
5139 backend dynamic
5140 fullconn 10000
5141 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5142 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5143
5144 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5145
5146
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02005147grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005148 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
5149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01005150 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005151 Arguments :
5152 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
5153 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
5154 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
5155
5156 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
5157 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005158 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005159 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
5160
5161 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
5162 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
5163 simplify it.
5164
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005165
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005166hash-balance-factor <factor>
5167 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5169 yes | no | no | yes
5170 Arguments :
5171 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5172 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005173 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005174
5175 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5176 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5177 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5178 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5179 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5180 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5181 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5182
5183 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5184 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5185 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5186 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5187 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5188
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005189 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5190 consistent hashing mechanism.
5191
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005192 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5193
5194
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005195hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005196 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5198 yes | no | yes | yes
5199 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005200 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5201 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005202
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005203 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5204 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5205 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5206 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5207 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5208 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5209 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5210 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5211 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5212 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005213
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005214 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5215 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5216 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5217 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5218 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5219 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5220 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5221 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5222 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5223 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5224 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5225 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5226 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005227 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5228 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005229
5230 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5231
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005232 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005233 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5234 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5235 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005236 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5237 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5238 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005239
5240 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5241 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005242 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5243 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5244 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5245 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5246
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005247 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005248 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5249 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5250 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5251 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5252 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5253 parameter.
5254
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005255 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5256 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5257 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5258 used on strings.
5259
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005260 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5261
5262 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5263 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5264 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5265 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5266 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5267 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5268 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5269 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5270 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5271 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5272 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5273 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005274
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005275 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5276 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5277 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005278
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005279 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005280
5281
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005282http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5283 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5284 ones).
5285
5286 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5287 no | yes | yes | yes
5288
5289 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5290 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5291 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5292 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5293 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5294 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5295
5296 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5297 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5298 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5299
5300 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5301 below.
5302
5303 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5304 instance.
5305
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005306 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5307 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5308 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5309
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005310 Example:
5311 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5312 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5313 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5314
5315http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5316
5317 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5318 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5319 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5320 example, or to pass some internal information.
5321 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5322 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5323 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5324
5325http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5326
5327 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5328 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5329
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005330http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005331
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005332 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5333 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5334 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5335 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5336 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005337
5338http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5339 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5340
5341 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5342
5343 Example:
5344 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5345
5346 # applied to:
5347 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5348
5349 # outputs:
5350 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5351
5352 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5353
5354http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5355 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5356
5357 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5358
5359 Example:
5360 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5361
5362 # applied to:
5363 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5364
5365 # outputs:
5366 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5367
5368http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5369
5370 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5371 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5372 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5373
5374http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5375 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5376
5377 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5378 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5379 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5380 fallback.
5381
5382 Example:
5383 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5384 http-response set-status 431
5385 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5386 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5387
5388http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5389
5390 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5391 inline.
5392
5393 Arguments:
5394 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5395 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5396 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5397 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5398 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5399 (request and response)
5400 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5401 processing
5402 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5403 processing
5404 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5405 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5406 and '_'.
5407
5408 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5409 followed by some converters.
5410
5411 Example:
5412 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5413
5414http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5415
5416 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5417 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5418 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5419 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5420 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005421 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005422 processing.
5423
5424 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5425 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005426 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005427 rules evaluation.
5428
5429http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5430
5431 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5432 details about <var-name>.
5433
5434 Example:
5435 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5436
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005437
5438http-check comment <string>
5439 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5440 it fails.
5441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5442 yes | no | yes | yes
5443
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005444 Arguments :
5445 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5446 rule fails.
5447
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005448 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5449 user-friendly error reporting.
5450
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005451 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005452 "http-check expect".
5453
5454
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005455http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5456 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005457 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005458 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5460 yes | no | yes | yes
5461
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005462 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005463 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5464
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005465 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005466 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005467
5468 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5469 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5470 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5471 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5472
5473 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5474
5475 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5476
5477 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5478
5479 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5480
5481 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5482
5483 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5484 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5485 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5486 is used.
5487
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005488 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5489 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5490 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5491 haproxy -vv.
5492
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005493 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5494
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005495 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5496 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5497 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5498 different ports or with different servers.
5499
5500 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5501 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5502 the port with a "http-check connect".
5503
5504 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5505 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5506 do.
5507
5508 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5509 unset-var or comment rules.
5510
5511 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005512 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5513 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5514 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5515 option httpchk
5516
5517 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005518 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005519 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005520 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005521 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005522 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005523
5524 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5525
5526 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005527
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005528
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005529http-check disable-on-404
5530 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005532 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005533 Arguments : none
5534
5535 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5536 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5537 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5538 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5539 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5540 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5541 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5542 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005543 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5544 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005545 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5546 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5547 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005548
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005549 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005550
5551
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005552http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005553 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5554 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5555 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005556 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005558 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005559
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005560 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005561 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5562
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005563 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5564 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5565 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5566 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5567 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5568 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5569 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5570 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5571 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5572 result is always conclusive.
5573
5574 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5575 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5576 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005577 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5578 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005579 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5580 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005581 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5582 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5583 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005584
5585 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5586 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005587 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5588 supported :
5589 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5590 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005591 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5592 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5593 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5594 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5595 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005596
5597 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5598 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005599 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5600 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5601 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5602 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005603 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5604
5605 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5606 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5607 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5608 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5609
5610 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5611 informational message reported in logs if an error
5612 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5613 log-format string.
5614
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005615 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005616 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5617 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005618 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5619 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5620 details on the supported keywords.
5621
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005622 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5623 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5624 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5625 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005626
5627 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5628 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5629 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5630 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5631 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5632
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005633 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5634 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5635 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5636 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5637 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5638 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5639 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005640
5641 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005642 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005643 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5644 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5645 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5646 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5647
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005648 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5649 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005650 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5651 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5652 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5653 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5654 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5655 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5656 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5657 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005658 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5659 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5660 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5661 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5662 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5663 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5664 insensitive on the header names.
5665
5666 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5667 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5668 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5669 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5670 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5671 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005672
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005673 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005674 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005675 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5676 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5677 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5678 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5679 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005680 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005681 trace).
5682
5683 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005684 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005685 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5686 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5687 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5688 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5689 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005690 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005691
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005692 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5693 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5694 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5695 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5696 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5697 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5698
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005699 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005700 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005701 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5702 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5703 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5704 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5705 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5706 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5707
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005708 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5709 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5710 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5711 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5712 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005713
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005714 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5715 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5716
5717 Examples :
5718 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005719 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005720
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005721 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5722 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5723
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005724 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005725 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005726
5727 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005728 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005729
5730 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005731 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005732
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005733 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005734 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005735
5736
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005737http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005738 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5739 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005740 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5741 health checks.
5742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5743 yes | no | yes | yes
5744 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005745 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5746
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005747 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5748 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5749 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5750 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5751 to invent non-standard ones.
5752
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005753 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5754 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5755 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5756 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5757
5758 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5759 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5760 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5761 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005762
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005763 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005764 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005765 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005766 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5767 to add it.
5768
5769 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5770 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5771 to the log-format rules.
5772
5773 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5774 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5775 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005776
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005777 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5778 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5779 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5780 request.
5781
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005782 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5783 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5784 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005785 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5786 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5787 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5788 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005789 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005790
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005791 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005792 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5793 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005794
5795 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5796 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5797 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5798 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5799 configured request authority.
5800
5801 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5802 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005803
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005804 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005805
5806
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005807http-check send-state
5808 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5810 yes | no | yes | yes
5811 Arguments : none
5812
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005813 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005814 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005815 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5816 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
5817 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005818
5819 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5820 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5821 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5822 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5823 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005824 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5825 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5826 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5827
5828 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5829 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5830 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5831
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005832 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5833 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5834 checked in multiple backends.
5835
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005836 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005837 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5838
5839 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5840 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5841 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5842 one fails.
5843
5844 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5845 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5846 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5847
5848 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5849 server's queue.
5850
5851 Example of a header received by the application server :
5852 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5853 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5854
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005855 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5856 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005857
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005858
5859http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005860 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005861 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5862 yes | no | yes | yes
5863
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005864 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005865 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5866 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5867 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5868 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5869 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5870 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5871 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5872 and '-'.
5873
5874 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5875
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005876 Examples :
5877 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005878
5879
5880http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005881 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005882 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5883 yes | no | yes | yes
5884
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005885 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005886 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5887 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5888 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5889 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5890 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5891 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5892 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5893 and '-'.
5894
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005895 Examples :
5896 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005897
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005898
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005899http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5900 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5901 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5902 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5903 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5905 yes | yes | yes | yes
5906 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005907 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005908 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005909 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005910 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005911
5912 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5913 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5914 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5915 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5916
5917 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5918 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5919 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5920 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5921
5922 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5923 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5924 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5925 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5926 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5927 chroot is performed.
5928
5929 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5930 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5931 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5932 considered.
5933
5934 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5935 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5936 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5937 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5938 considered as a raw string.
5939
5940 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5941 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5942 "content-type".
5943
5944 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5945 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5946 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5947 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5948 evaluated as a log-format string.
5949
5950 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5951 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5952 argument to "content-type".
5953
5954 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5955 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5956 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5957 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5958
5959 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5960 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5961 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5962 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5963 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5964 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5965 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5966 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5967
5968 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5969 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5970 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5971
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005972 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5973 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5974 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5975 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5976 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5977
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005978 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5979 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5980
5981
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005982http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005983 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5984
5985 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5986 no | yes | yes | yes
5987
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005988 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5989 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5990 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5991 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5992 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005993
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005994 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5995 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005996
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005997 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005998
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005999 Example:
6000 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
6001 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
6002 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006003
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006004 http-request allow if nagios
6005 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
6006 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
6007 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01006008
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006009 Example:
6010 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
6011 acl add path /addacl
6012 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006013
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006014 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006015
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006016 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
6017 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006018
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006019 Example:
6020 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
6021 acl setmap path /setmap
6022 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006023
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006024 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006025
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006026 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
6027 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006028
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006029 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6030 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006031
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006032http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006033
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006034 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6035 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6036 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6037 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6038 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6039 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6040 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6041 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006042
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006043http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006044
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006045 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6046 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6047 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6048 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6049 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6050 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6051 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6052 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006053
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006054http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006055
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006056 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
6057 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006058
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006059
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006060http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006061
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006062 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6063 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6064 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6065 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6066 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006067
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006068 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6069 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6070 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6071 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6072 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6073 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6074 instead.
6075
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006076 Example:
6077 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6078 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006079
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006080http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006081
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006082 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006083
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006084http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6085 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006086
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006087 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6088 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6089 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6090 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6091 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6092 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6093 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6094 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6095 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006096
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006097 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6098 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6099 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006100 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6101
6102 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6103 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6104 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6105 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006106
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006107http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006108
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006109 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6110 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6111 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6112 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6113 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6114 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006115
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006116http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006117
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006118 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6119 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6120 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6121 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6122 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006123
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006124http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006125
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006126 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6127 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6128 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6129 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6130 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6131 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006132
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006133http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6134http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6135 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6136 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6137 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6138 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006139
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006140 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6141 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6142 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006143 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006144 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6145 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6146 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006147 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006148 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006149
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006150http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6151 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6152 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6153 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6154
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006155http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6156
6157 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6158 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6159 pointed by <resolvers>.
6160 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6161 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6162 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6163 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6164 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6165 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6166 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6167 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6168 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6169 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
William Lallemandac83dba2022-08-26 16:38:43 +02006170 to 0.0.0.0. The do-resolve action takes an host-only parameter, any port must
6171 be removed from the string.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006172
6173 Example:
6174 resolvers mydns
6175 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6176 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6177 timeout retry 1s
6178 hold valid 10s
6179 hold nx 3s
6180 hold other 3s
6181 hold obsolete 0s
6182 accepted_payload_size 8192
6183
6184 frontend fe
6185 bind 10.42.0.1:80
William Lallemandac83dba2022-08-26 16:38:43 +02006186 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower,regsub(:[0-9]*$,)
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006187 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6188
6189 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6190 # which mean DNS resolution error
6191 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6192
6193 default_backend be
6194
6195 backend b_503
6196 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6197 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6198 # 503 error page to end users
6199
6200 backend be
6201 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6202 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6203 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6204 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6205 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6206
6207 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6208 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6209
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006210http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6211
6212 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6213 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6214 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6215 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006216 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6217 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006218
6219 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6220
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006221http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006222http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006223http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006224http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006225http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006226http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006227http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006228http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6229http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006230
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006231 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6232
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006233 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006234 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6235 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6236 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6237 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006238
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006239 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6240 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6241 the supported backend.
6242
6243 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6244 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6245 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6246 number of segments in the path.
6247
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006248 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6249 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6250 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6251 when improperly combined.
6252
6253 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6254 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6255 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6256 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6257 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6258
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006259 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006260
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006261 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6262
6263 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6264 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6265
6266 Example:
6267 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6268
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006269 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6270
6271 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6272 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6273
6274 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6275 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6276
6277 Example:
6278 - /#foo -> /
6279
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006280 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6281 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006282
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006283 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6284 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6285
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006286 Example:
6287 - /. -> /
6288 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6289 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6290 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006291
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006292 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6293 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6294
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006295 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006296 their preceding segment.
6297
6298 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6299 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6300
6301 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6302 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006303
6304 Example:
6305 - /foo/../ -> /
6306 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6307 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6308 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006309 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006310 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006311 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006312
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006313 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6314 removed as well:
6315
6316 Example:
6317 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6318 - /bar/../../ -> /
6319
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006320 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6321 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006322
6323 Example:
6324 - // -> /
6325 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6326
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006327 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6328 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6329
6330 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6331 ".", "_", and "~".
6332
6333 Example:
6334 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6335 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6336 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6337 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6338
6339 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6340 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6341
6342 Example:
6343 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6344 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6345
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006346 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006347 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006348
6349 Example:
6350 - /%6f -> /%6F
6351 - /%zz -> /%zz
6352
6353 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6354 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6355
6356 Example:
6357 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6358
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006359 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006360 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6361 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6362
6363 Example:
6364 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6365 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6366 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6367
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006368http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006369
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006370 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6371 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6372 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6373 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6374 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006375
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006376http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006377
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006378 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6379 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6380 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6381 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006382
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006383http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6384 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006385
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006386 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006387 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6388 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6389 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6390 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6391 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006392
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006393 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6394 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6395 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6396 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6397 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006398
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006399 Example:
6400 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6401
6402 # applied to:
6403 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6404
6405 # outputs:
6406 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6407
6408 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006409
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006410 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6411
6412 # applied to:
6413 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006414
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006415 # outputs:
6416 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006417
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006418http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6419 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6420
6421 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6422 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006423 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6424 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6425 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006426
6427 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6428 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6429 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6430
6431 Example:
6432 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6433 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6434
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006435 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6436 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6437 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6438 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6439
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006440http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6441 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6442
6443 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6444 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6445 query-string are replaced.
6446
6447 Example:
6448 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6449 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6450
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006451http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6452 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6453
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006454 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6455 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6456 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6457 against.
6458
6459 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6460 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6461 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006462
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006463 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6464 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6465 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6466 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6467 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6468 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6469 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6470 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6471 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006472 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6473 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006474
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006475 Example:
6476 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6477 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006478
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006479 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6480 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006481
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006482http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6483 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006484
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006485 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6486 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6487 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6488 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006489
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006490 Example:
6491 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006492
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006493 # applied to:
6494 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006495
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006496 # outputs:
6497 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006498
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006499http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6500 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6501 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006502 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006503 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6504
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006505 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006506 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6507 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006508 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006509 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006510 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006511 are followed to create the response :
6512
6513 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6514 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6515 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6516 ignored.
6517
6518 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6519 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006520 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006521 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6522 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006523
6524 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6525 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6526 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006527 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006528 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006529
6530 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6531 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6532 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006533 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006534 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006535 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006536
6537 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6538 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6539 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6540 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6541 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6542 as a raw content.
6543
6544 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6545 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6546 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6547 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6548 considered as a raw string.
6549
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006550 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006551 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6552 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6553 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6554
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006555 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6556 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006557 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006558
6559 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6560
6561 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006562 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006563 if { path /ping }
6564
6565 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6566 if { path /favicon.ico }
6567
6568 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6569 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6570 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6571
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006572http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6573http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006574
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006575 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6576 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6577 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006578
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006579http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6580 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006581
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006582 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6583 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6584 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6585 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006586
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006587http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006588
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006589 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6590 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6591 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6592 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6593 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006594
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006595 Arguments:
6596 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6597 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006598
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006599 Example:
6600 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6601 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006602
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006603 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6604 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006605
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006606http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006607
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006608 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6609 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6610 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006611
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006612 Arguments:
6613 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6614 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006615
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006616 Example:
6617 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6618 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006619
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006620 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6621 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6622 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006623
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006624http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006625
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006626 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6627 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6628 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6629 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6630 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006631
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006632 Example:
6633 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6634 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6635 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6636 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6637 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6638 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6639 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6640 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6641 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006642
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006643http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006644
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006645 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6646 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6647 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6648 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6649 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006650
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006651http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6652 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006653
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006654 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6655 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6656 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6657 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6658 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6659 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6660 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6661 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6662 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006663
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006664http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006665
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006666 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6667 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6668 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6669 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6670 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6671 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6672 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006673
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006674http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006675
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006676 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6677 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6678 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006679
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006680http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006681
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006682 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6683 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6684 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6685 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6686 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6687 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6688 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6689 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006690
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006691http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006692
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006693 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6694 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6695 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6696 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6697 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6698 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006699
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006700 Example :
6701 # prepend the host name before the path
6702 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006703
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006704http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6705
6706 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6707 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6708 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6709
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006710http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006711
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006712 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6713 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6714 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6715 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6716 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006717
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006718http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006719
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006720 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6721 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6722 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6723 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6724 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6725 values have higher priority.
6726 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6727 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6728 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6729 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6730 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006731
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006732http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006733
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006734 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6735 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6736 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6737 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6738 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6739 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6740 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006741
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006742 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006743
6744 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006745 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6746 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006747
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006748http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6749 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6750 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6751 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006752 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6753 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006754
6755 Arguments :
6756 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6757 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006758
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006759 See also "option forwardfor".
6760
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006761 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006762 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6763 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6764
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006765 # After the masking this will track connections
6766 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6767 http-request track-sc0 src
6768
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006769 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6770 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6771
6772http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6773
6774 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6775 expression.
6776
6777 Arguments:
6778 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6779 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006780
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006781 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006782 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6783 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6784
6785 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6786 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6787 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6788
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006789http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006790 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6791
6792 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6793 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6794 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6795 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6796 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6797
6798 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6799 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6800 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6801 results.
6802
6803 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006804 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6805 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006806
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006807http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6808
6809 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6810 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6811 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6812 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6813 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6814 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6815 information from the request.
6816
6817 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6818
6819http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6820
6821 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6822 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6823 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6824 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6825 path and the query string.
6826 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6827
6828http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6829
6830 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6831 inline.
6832
6833 Arguments:
6834 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6835 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6836 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6837 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6838 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6839 (request and response)
6840 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6841 processing
6842 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6843 processing
6844 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6845 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6846 and '_'.
6847
6848 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6849 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006850
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006851 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006852 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006853
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006854http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6855 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006856
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006857 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6858 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6859 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6860 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6861 agent name must be used.
6862
6863 Arguments:
6864 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6865
6866 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6867 configuration.
6868
6869http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6870
6871 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6872 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6873 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6874 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6875 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6876 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6877 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6878 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6879 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6880 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6881 action.
6882 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6883 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6884 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6885 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6886 you fully understand how it works.
6887
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006888http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6889
6890 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6891 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6892 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6893 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6894 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006895 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006896 processing.
6897
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006898 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006899 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6900 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6901 rules evaluation.
6902
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006903http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6904http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6905 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6906 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6907 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6908 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006909
6910 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6911 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6912 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006913 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6914 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6915 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6916 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6917 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6918 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006919 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006920 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6921 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6922 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006923 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006924 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6925 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6926 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6927 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6928 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006929
6930http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6931http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6932http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6933
6934 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6935 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6936 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6937 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006938 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006939 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6940 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6941 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6942 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6943 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6944 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6945 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6946
6947 Arguments :
6948 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6949 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6950 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6951 select which table entry to update the counters.
6952
6953 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6954 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6955 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6956 that table until the session ends.
6957
6958 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6959 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6960 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6961 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6962 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6963 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6964 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6965 useful information.
6966
6967 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6968 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6969 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6970 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6971 checks that make use of it.
6972
6973http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6974
6975 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006976
6977 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006978 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006979
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006980http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6981
6982 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6983 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6984 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6985 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6986 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6987 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6988
6989 Arguments :
6990 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6991
6992 Example:
6993 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6994
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006995http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6996 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6997
6998 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
6999 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7000 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7001 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7002 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
7003 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
7004 http-buffer-request".
7005
7006 Arguments :
7007
7008 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7009 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7010
7011 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007012 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007013 bytes.
7014
7015 Example:
7016 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
7017
7018 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7019
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007020http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007021
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007022 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
7023 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
7024 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007025
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01007026
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007027http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007028 Access control for Layer 7 responses
7029
7030 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7031 no | yes | yes | yes
7032
7033 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7034 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7035 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7036 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7037 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7038 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7039
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007040 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
7041 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007042
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007043 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007044
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007045 Example:
7046 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007047
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007048 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007049
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007050 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7051 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007052
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007053 Example:
7054 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007055
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007056 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007057
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007058 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7059 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007060
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007061 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7062 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007063
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007064http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007065
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007066 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7067 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7068 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7069 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
7070 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7071 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7072 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7073 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007074
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007075http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007076
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007077 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
7078 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
7079 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
7080 example, or to pass some internal information.
7081 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
7082 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
7083 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007084
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007085http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007086
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007087 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7088 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007089
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007090http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007091
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007092 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007093
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007094http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007095
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007096 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7097 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7098 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7099 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7100 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7101 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7102 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007103
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007104 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7105 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7106 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7107 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7108 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007109
7110 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7111 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7112 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7113 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007114
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007115http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007116
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007117 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7118 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7119 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7120 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7121 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7122 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007123
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007124http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007125
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007126 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7127 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7128 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7129 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7130 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007131
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007132http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007133
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007134 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7135 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7136 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7137 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7138 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7139 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007140
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007141http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7142http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7143 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7144 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7145 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7146 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007147
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007148 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7149 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7150 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007151 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007152 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7153 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7154 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007155 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007156 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007157
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007158http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007159
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007160 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7161 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7162 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7163 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7164 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7165 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007166
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007167http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7168 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007169
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007170 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7171 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007172
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007173 Example:
7174 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007175
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007176 # applied to:
7177 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007178
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007179 # outputs:
7180 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007181
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007182 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007183
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007184http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7185 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007186
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007187 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007188 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007189
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007190 Example:
7191 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007192
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007193 # applied to:
7194 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007195
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007196 # outputs:
7197 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007198
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007199http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7200 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7201 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007202 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007203 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7204
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007205 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007206 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7207 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007208 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007209 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007210 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007211 are followed to create the response :
7212
7213 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7214 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7215 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7216 ignored.
7217
7218 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7219 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007220 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007221 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7222 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007223
7224 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7225 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7226 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007227 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007228 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007229
7230 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7231 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7232 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007233 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007234 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007235 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007236
7237 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7238 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7239 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7240 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7241 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7242 as a raw content.
7243
7244 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7245 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7246 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7247 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7248 considered as a raw string.
7249
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007250 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7251 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7252 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7253 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7254
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007255 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7256 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007257 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007258
7259 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7260
7261 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007262 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007263 if { status eq 404 }
7264
7265 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7266 string "This is the end !" \
7267 if { status eq 500 }
7268
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007269http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7270http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007271
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007272 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7273 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7274 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007275
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007276http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7277 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007278
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007279 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7280 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7281 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7282 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007283
Christopher Faulet68fc3a12021-08-12 09:32:07 +02007284http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7285 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007286
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007287 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7288 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7289 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7290 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7291 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007292
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007293 Arguments:
7294 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007295
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007296 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7297 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007298
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007299http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007300
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007301 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7302 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7303 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007304
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007305http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7306
7307 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7308 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7309 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7310 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7311 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7312
7313http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7314
7315 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7316 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7317 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7318 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7319 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7320 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7321 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7322 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7323 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7324
7325http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7326
7327 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
7328 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7329 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
7330 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
7331 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
7332 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
7333 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
7334
7335http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7336
7337 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7338 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7339 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7340 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7341 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7342 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7343 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7344 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7345
7346http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7347 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7348
7349 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7350 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7351 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7352 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007353
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007354 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007355 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7356 http-response set-status 431
7357 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7358 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007359
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007360http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007361
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007362 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7363 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7364 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7365 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7366 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7367 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7368 based on some information from the request.
7369
7370 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7371
7372http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7373
7374 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7375 inline.
7376
7377 Arguments:
7378 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7379 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7380 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7381 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7382 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7383 (request and response)
7384 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7385 processing
7386 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7387 processing
7388 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7389 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7390 and '_'.
7391
7392 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7393 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007394
7395 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007396 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007397
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007398http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007399
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007400 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7401 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7402 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7403 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7404 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7405 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7406 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7407 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7408 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7409 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7410 action.
7411 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7412 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7413 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7414 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7415 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007416
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007417http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7418
7419 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7420 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7421 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7422 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7423 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007424 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007425 processing.
7426
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007427 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007428 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007429 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007430 rules evaluation.
7431
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007432http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7433http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7434http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007435
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007436 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7437 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7438 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7439 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7440 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007441 supported, HAProxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007442
7443http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7444
7445 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7446 about <var-name>.
7447
7448 Example:
7449 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7450
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007451http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7452 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7453
7454 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7455 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7456 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7457 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7458 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7459 buffer is full.
7460
7461 Arguments :
7462
7463 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7464 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7465
7466 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007467 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007468 bytes.
7469
7470 Example:
7471 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007472
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007473http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7474 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7475
7476 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7477 yes | no | yes | yes
7478
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007479 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007480 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7481 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7482 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007483
7484 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7485
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007486 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7487 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7488 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7489 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7490 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7491 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7492 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007493 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007494 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7495 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007496
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007497 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7498 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7499 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7500 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7501 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7502 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7503 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007504 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7505 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7506 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7507 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7508 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7509 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007510
7511 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7512 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7513 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7514 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7515 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7516 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7517 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7518 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007519 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007520 downsides of rare connection failures.
7521
7522 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7523 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7524 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7525 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7526 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7527 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007528 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007529 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7530 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7531 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7532 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7533 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7534
7535 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007536 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7537 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7538 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7539 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007540
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007541 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7542 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007543
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007544 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007545
7546 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7547 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7548 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7549
7550 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7551
7552
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007553http-send-name-header [<header>]
7554 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007555 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7556 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007557 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007558 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7559
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007560 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7561 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7562 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7563 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7564 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7565 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7566 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7567 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7568 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7569 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7570 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7571 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7572 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7573 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7574 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7575 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007576
7577 See also : "server"
7578
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007579id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007580 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7582 no | yes | yes | yes
7583 Arguments : none
7584
7585 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7586 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7587 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007588
7589
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007590ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7591 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7592 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007593 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007594
7595 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7596 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7597 and running).
7598
7599 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7600 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7601 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007602 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007603 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7604
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007605 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7606 "unless" condition is met.
7607
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007608 Example:
7609 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7610 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7611 ignore-persist if url_static
7612
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007613 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7614
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007615load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7616 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7617 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7618 yes | no | yes | yes
7619
7620 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7621 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7622 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007623 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007624 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007625 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7626 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7627 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7628
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007629 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007630 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007631 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007632
7633 Arguments:
7634 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7635 named "server-state-file".
7636
7637 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7638 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7639 name is used as a file name.
7640
7641 none don't load any stat for this backend
7642
7643 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007644 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7645 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7646 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007647 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007648 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007649
7650 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7651 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7652
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007653 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007654
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007655 global
7656 stats socket /tmp/socket
7657 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007658
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007659 defaults
7660 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007661
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007662 backend bk
7663 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7664 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007665
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007666
7667 Then one can run :
7668
7669 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7670
7671 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7672
7673 1
7674 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7675 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7676 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7677
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007678 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007679
7680 global
7681 stats socket /tmp/socket
7682 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7683
7684 defaults
7685 load-server-state-from-file local
7686
7687 backend bk
7688 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7689 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7690
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007691
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007692 Then one can run :
7693
7694 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7695
7696 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7697
7698 1
7699 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7700 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7701 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7702
7703 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7704 "show servers state"
7705
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007706
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007707log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007708log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007709 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007710no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007711 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7713 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007714
7715 Prefix :
7716 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7717 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7718 prefix does not allow arguments.
7719
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007720 Arguments :
7721 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7722 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7723 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7724 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7725 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7726 parameter.
7727
7728 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7729 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7730
7731 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7732 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7733 standard syslog port).
7734
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007735 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7736 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7737 standard syslog port).
7738
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007739 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7740 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7741 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007742 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007743
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007744 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7745 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7746 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7747 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7748 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7749 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7750 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7751 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7752 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7753 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7754 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7755 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007756 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007757 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7758 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7759 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007760 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7761 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007762
7763 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7764 and "fd@2", see above.
7765
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007766 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7767 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7768 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7769 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7770 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7771 having the logs instantly available.
7772
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007773 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7774 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7775 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7776
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007777 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7778 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007779
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007780 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7781 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7782 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7783 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7784 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7785 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7786 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7787 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7788 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7789 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007790 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007791
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007792 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7793 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7794 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7795 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7796 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7797
7798 <sample_size>
7799 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7800 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7801 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7802 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7803 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7804
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007805 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7806 one of the following :
7807
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007808 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7809 field is stripped. This is the default.
7810 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7811 rfc3164.
7812
7813 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007814 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7815
7816 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7817 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7818
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007819 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7820 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7821 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7822 designed to be used with a local log server.
7823
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007824 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7825 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7826 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7827 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7828 systemd logger consumes.
7829
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007830 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7831 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7832 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7833 used with a local log server.
7834
7835 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7836 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7837 designed to be used with a local log server.
7838
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007839 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7840 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7841 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7842 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7843
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007844 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7845
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007846 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7847 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7848 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7849
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007850 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7851 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7852 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7853 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007854
7855 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7856 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7857 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007858 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7859 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7860 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7861 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7862 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007863
7864 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7865
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007866 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7867 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7868 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007869
7870 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7871 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7872 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7873 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7874
7875 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7876 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007877
7878 Example :
7879 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007880 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7881 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7882 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007883 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007884 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7885 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007886 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007887
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007888
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007889log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007890 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7891 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7892 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007893
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007894 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7895 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7896 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7897 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7898 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007899
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007900 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7901 "option httplog" directives.
7902
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007903log-format-sd <string>
7904 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7905 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7906 yes | yes | yes | no
7907
7908 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7909 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7910 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7911 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7912 which covers the log format string in depth.
7913
7914 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7915 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7916
7917 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7918 log format to "rfc5424".
7919
7920 Example :
7921 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7922
7923
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007924log-tag <string>
7925 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7926 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7927 yes | yes | yes | yes
7928
7929 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7930 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007931 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007932 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7933 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7934 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7935 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7936 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7937 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007938
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007939max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7940 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7941 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7942 yes | no | yes | yes
7943
7944 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7945 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7946 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7947 servers.
7948
7949 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007950 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007951 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7952 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7953 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007954 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007955 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7956 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7957 picking a different server.
7958
7959 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7960 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7961 even if they have to be queued.
7962
7963 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7964 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7965
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007966max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7967 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7968 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7969 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007970
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007971maxconn <conns>
7972 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7974 yes | yes | yes | no
7975 Arguments :
7976 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7977 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7978 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7979 closes.
7980
7981 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007982 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007983 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7984 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007985 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7986 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7987 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7988 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007989
7990 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7991 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7992 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7993
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007994 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7995 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007996
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007997 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7998
7999
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02008000mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008001 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
8002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8003 yes | yes | yes | yes
8004 Arguments :
8005 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
8006 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
8007 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
8008 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
8009
8010 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
8011 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
8012 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
8013 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
8014 brings HAProxy most of its value.
8015
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008016 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
8017 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
8018 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008019
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008020 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008021 defaults http_instances
8022 mode http
8023
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008024
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008025monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008026 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8028 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008029 Arguments :
8030 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
8031 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008032 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008033 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
8034 backend and its backup.
8035
8036 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8037 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8038 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8039 servers in a list of backends.
8040
8041 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8042 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8043 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008044 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008045 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8046 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008047 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008048 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8049 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008050
8051 Example:
8052 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008053 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008054 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8055 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8056 monitor-uri /site_alive
8057 monitor fail if site_dead
8058
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008059 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008060
8061
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008062monitor-uri <uri>
8063 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8065 yes | yes | yes | no
8066 Arguments :
8067 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8068 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8069
8070 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8071 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8072 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8073 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8074 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8075 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8076 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8077 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8078
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008079 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008080 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8081 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
8082 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
8083 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8084 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8085 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008086
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008087 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8088 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8089 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8090 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8091
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008092 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008093 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008094 frontend www
8095 mode http
8096 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8097
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008098 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008099
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008100
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008101option abortonclose
8102no option abortonclose
8103 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8105 yes | no | yes | yes
8106 Arguments : none
8107
8108 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8109 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8110 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8111 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008112 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008113 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8114 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8115 encountered while delivering the response.
8116
8117 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8118 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8119 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8120 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8121 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8122 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008123 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008124 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008125 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008126 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8127 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8128 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8129
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008130 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8131 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008132 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8133 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8134 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8135 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8136 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8137 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008138 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008139
8140 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8141 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8142
8143 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8144
8145
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008146option accept-invalid-http-request
8147no option accept-invalid-http-request
8148 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8150 yes | yes | yes | no
8151 Arguments : none
8152
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008153 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008154 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008155 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008156 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8157 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8158 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8159 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8160 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008161 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8162 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8163 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8164 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008165 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008166 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008167 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8168 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8169 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008170
8171 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8172 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8173 been confirmed.
8174
8175 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8176 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008177 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8178 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008179 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8180
8181 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8182 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8183
8184 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8185 stats socket.
8186
8187
8188option accept-invalid-http-response
8189no option accept-invalid-http-response
8190 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8192 yes | no | yes | yes
8193 Arguments : none
8194
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008195 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008196 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008197 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008198 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8199 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8200 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8201 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8202 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008203 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8204 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8205 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008206
8207 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8208 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8209 been confirmed.
8210
8211 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8212 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8213 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8214 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8215
8216 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8217 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8218
8219 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8220 stats socket.
8221
8222
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008223option allbackups
8224no option allbackups
8225 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8227 yes | no | yes | yes
8228 Arguments : none
8229
8230 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8231 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8232 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8233 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8234 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8235 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8236 order between the backup servers anymore.
8237
8238 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8239 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8240
8241 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8242 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8243
8244
8245option checkcache
8246no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008247 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8249 yes | no | yes | yes
8250 Arguments : none
8251
8252 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8253 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008254 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008255 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8256 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008257 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008258
8259 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008260 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008261 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008262 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8263 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008264 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008265 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008266 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8267 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008268 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008269 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8270 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008271 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008272 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8273 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8274 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8275 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8276 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8277 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8278 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8279 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8280 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8281
8282 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008283 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8284 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8285 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8286 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008287
8288 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8289 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008290 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008291 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008292
8293 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8294 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8295
8296
8297option clitcpka
8298no option clitcpka
8299 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8301 yes | yes | yes | no
8302 Arguments : none
8303
8304 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8305 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008306 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008307 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8308
8309 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8310 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8311 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8312 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8313
8314 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8315 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8316 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8317 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8318 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8319
8320 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8321
8322 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8323 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8324 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8325
8326 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8327 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8328
8329 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8330
8331
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008332option contstats
8333 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8335 yes | yes | yes | no
8336 Arguments : none
8337
8338 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8339 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8340 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008341 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008342 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8343 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8344 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8345 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8346 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008347
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008348option disable-h2-upgrade
8349no option disable-h2-upgrade
8350 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8351 connection.
8352 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8353 yes | yes | yes | no
8354 Arguments : none
8355
8356 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8357 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8358 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8359 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008360 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8361 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8362 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8363 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8364 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8365 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008366
8367 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8368 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008369
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008370option dontlog-normal
8371no option dontlog-normal
8372 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8374 yes | yes | yes | no
8375 Arguments : none
8376
8377 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8378 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8379 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8380 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8381 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8382 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8383 logged.
8384
8385 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8386 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8387 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8388
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008389 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008390 logging.
8391
8392
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008393option dontlognull
8394no option dontlognull
8395 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8397 yes | yes | yes | no
8398 Arguments : none
8399
8400 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8401 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8402 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8403 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8404 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8405 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008406 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8407 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8408 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008409
8410 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008411 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008412 would not be logged.
8413
8414 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8415 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8416
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008417 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008418 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008419
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008420
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008421option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008422 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8424 yes | yes | yes | yes
8425 Arguments :
8426 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8427 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008428 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008429 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008430
8431 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8432 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8433 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8434 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8435 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8436 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8437 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008438 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8439 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8440 possible that the client has already brought one.
8441
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008442 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008443 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008444 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008445 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008446 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008447 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008448
8449 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8450 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8451 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8452 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8453 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8454 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008455 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008456
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008457 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8458 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008459 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008460 are under the control of the end-user.
8461
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008462 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008463 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8464 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008465 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8466 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8467 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008468
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008469 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008470 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8471 frontend www
8472 mode http
8473 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8474
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008475 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8476 backend www
8477 mode http
8478 option forwardfor header X-Client
8479
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008480 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008481 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008482
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008483
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008484option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8485no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8486 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8488 yes | yes | yes | no
8489 Arguments : none
8490
8491 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8492 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8493 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8494 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8495 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8496 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8497 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8498
8499 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8500 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8501 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8502 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8503 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8504 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8505 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8506 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8507 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8508 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8509
8510 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8511
8512 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8513 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8514
8515 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8516 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8517
8518
8519option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8520no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8521 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8523 yes | no | yes | yes
8524 Arguments : none
8525
8526 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8527 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8528 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8529 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8530 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8531 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8532 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8533
8534 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8535 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8536 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8537 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8538 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8539 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8540 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8541 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8542 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8543 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8544
8545 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8546
8547 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8548 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8549
8550 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8551 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8552
8553
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008554option http-buffer-request
8555no option http-buffer-request
8556 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8558 yes | yes | yes | yes
8559 Arguments : none
8560
8561 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8562 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8563 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8564 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8565 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8566 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008567 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8568 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8569 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8570 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008571
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008572 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8573 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008574
8575
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008576option http-ignore-probes
8577no option http-ignore-probes
8578 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8580 yes | yes | yes | no
8581 Arguments : none
8582
8583 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8584 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8585 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8586 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8587 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8588 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8589 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8590 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8591 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008592 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8593 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008594 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8595
8596 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8597 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8598 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8599 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8600 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8601 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8602 are often the only way to detect them.
8603
8604 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8605 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8606
8607 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8608
8609
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008610option http-keep-alive
8611no option http-keep-alive
8612 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8614 yes | yes | yes | yes
8615 Arguments : none
8616
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008617 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8618 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008619 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8620 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008621 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8622 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8623 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008624
8625 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8626 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008627 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8628 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8629 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8630 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8631 situations where this option may be useful :
8632
8633 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008634 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008635
8636 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8637 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8638
8639 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8640 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8641 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8642 request.
8643
8644 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8645 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008646 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8647 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8648 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008649
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008650 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8651 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8652 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8653 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8654 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8655 not set.
8656
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008657 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8658 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8659 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008660
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008661 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008662 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008663 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008664
8665
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008666option http-no-delay
8667no option http-no-delay
8668 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8670 yes | yes | yes | yes
8671 Arguments : none
8672
8673 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8674 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8675 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8676 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8677 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8678 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8679 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008680 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008681 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8682 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8683 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8684 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8685 affected.
8686
8687 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8688 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8689 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8690 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8691 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8692 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8693 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8694 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8695 latency environments.
8696
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008697 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8698
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008699
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008700option http-pretend-keepalive
8701no option http-pretend-keepalive
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008702 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008704 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008705 Arguments : none
8706
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008707 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008708 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8709 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8710 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008711 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents HAProxy from
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008712 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8713 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8714 consider the response complete.
8715
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008716 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008717 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008718 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008719 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008720 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008721 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8722
8723 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8724 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8725 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8726 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008727 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8728 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008729 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8730
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008731 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8732 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8733 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8734 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8735 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8736 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008737
8738 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8739 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8740
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008741 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008742 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008743
Christopher Faulet79507152022-05-16 11:43:10 +02008744option http-restrict-req-hdr-names { preserve | delete | reject }
8745 Set HAProxy policy about HTTP request header names containing characters
8746 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset
8747 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8748 yes | yes | yes | yes
8749 Arguments :
8750 preserve disable the filtering. It is the default mode for HTTP proxies
8751 with no FastCGI application configured.
8752
8753 delete remove request headers with a name containing a character
8754 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset. It is the default mode for
8755 HTTP backends with a configured FastCGI application.
8756
8757 reject reject the request with a 403-Forbidden response if it contains a
8758 header name with a character outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset.
8759
8760 This option may be used to restrict the request header names to alphanumeric
8761 and hyphen characters ([A-Za-z0-9-]). This may be mandatory to interoperate
8762 with non-HTTP compliant servers that fail to handle some characters in header
8763 names. It may also be mandatory for FastCGI applications because all
8764 non-alphanumeric characters in header names are replaced by an underscore
8765 ('_'). Thus, it is easily possible to mix up header names and bypass some
8766 rules. For instance, "X-Forwarded-For" and "X_Forwarded-For" headers are both
8767 converted to "HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR" in FastCGI.
8768
8769 Note this option is evaluated per proxy and after the http-request rules
8770 evaluation.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008771
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008772option http-server-close
8773no option http-server-close
8774 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8776 yes | yes | yes | yes
8777 Arguments : none
8778
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008779 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8780 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8781 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8782 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008783 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8784 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8785 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8786 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8787 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8788 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8789 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8790 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8791 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8792 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8793 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008794
8795 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8796 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8797 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8798 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008799 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8800 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008801
8802 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8803 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008804 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8805 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8806 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008807
8808 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8809 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8810
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008811 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8812 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008813
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008814option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008815no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008816 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8818 yes | yes | yes | no
8819 Arguments : none
8820
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008821 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008822 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8823 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8824 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8825 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8826 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008827 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008828
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008829 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008830 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008831 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8832 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8833 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008834
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008835 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8836 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8837 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8838 front of an existing proxy.
8839
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008840 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8841
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008842 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008843
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008844option httpchk
8845option httpchk <uri>
8846option httpchk <method> <uri>
8847option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008848 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8850 yes | no | yes | yes
8851 Arguments :
8852 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8853 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8854 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8855 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8856 ones.
8857
8858 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8859 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8860 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8861
8862 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8863 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8864 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008865 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008866
8867 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8868 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8869 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8870 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8871 the lack of any response.
8872
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008873 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8874 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8875 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8876 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8877
8878 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8879 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8880 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008881
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008882 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8883 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008884 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008885 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008886 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008887
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008888 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8889 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8890 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8891 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8892
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008893 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008894 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8895 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8896 backend https_relay
8897 mode tcp
8898 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8899 http-check send hdr Host www
8900 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008901
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008902 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8903 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8904 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008905
8906
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008907option httpclose
8908no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008909 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8911 yes | yes | yes | yes
8912 Arguments : none
8913
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008914 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8915 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8916 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8917 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008918 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008919
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008920 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8921 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008922 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008923 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8924 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008925
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008926 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8927 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8928 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008929
8930 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8931 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008932 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8933 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8934 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008935
8936 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8937 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8938
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008939 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008940
8941
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008942option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008943 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008945 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008946 Arguments :
8947 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8948 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8949 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008950 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008951 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008952
8953 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8954 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8955 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8956 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8957 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8958 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8959 ports.
8960
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008961 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8962 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008963
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008964 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8965
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008966 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008967
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008968
8969option http_proxy
8970no option http_proxy
8971 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8973 yes | yes | yes | yes
8974 Arguments : none
8975
8976 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8977 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8978 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8979 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8980 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8981
8982 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8983 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008984 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8985 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008986
8987 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8988 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8989
8990 Example :
8991 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8992 backend direct_forward
8993 option httpclose
8994 option http_proxy
8995
8996 See also : "option httpclose"
8997
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008998
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008999option independent-streams
9000no option independent-streams
9001 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9003 yes | yes | yes | yes
9004 Arguments : none
9005
9006 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
9007 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
9008 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
9009 receive data or not.
9010
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009011 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009012 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
9013 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
9014 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
9015 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
9016 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
9017 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
9018 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
9019 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
9020 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
9021 socket buffers.
9022
9023 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
9024 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
9025 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
9026 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
9027 slow lines, so use it with caution.
9028
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009029 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009030
9031
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02009032option ldap-check
9033 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
9034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9035 yes | no | yes | yes
9036 Arguments : none
9037
9038 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
9039 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
9040 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
9041 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
9042
9043 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
9044 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
9045
9046 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
9047 configure it.
9048
9049 Example :
9050 option ldap-check
9051
9052 See also : "option httpchk"
9053
9054
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009055option external-check
9056 Use external processes for server health checks
9057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9058 yes | no | yes | yes
9059
9060 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
9061 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
9062 command".
9063
9064 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
9065
9066 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
9067
9068
William Dauchy4711a892022-01-05 22:53:24 +01009069option idle-close-on-response
9070no option idle-close-on-response
9071 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
9072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9073 yes | yes | yes | no
9074 Arguments : none
9075
9076 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
9077 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
9078 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
9079 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
9080 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
9081 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
9082 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
9083 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
9084 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
9085
9086 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
9087 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
9088
9089 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
9090 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
9091 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
9092 needed in case of frequent reloads.
9093
9094 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
9095 "hard-stop-after"
9096
9097
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009098option log-health-checks
9099no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009100 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9102 yes | no | yes | yes
9103 Arguments : none
9104
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009105 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9106 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9107 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009108
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009109 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9110 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9111 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9112 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9113 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9114
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009115 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009116 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009117
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009118 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9119 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9120 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009121
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009122
9123option log-separate-errors
9124no option log-separate-errors
9125 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9127 yes | yes | yes | no
9128 Arguments : none
9129
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009130 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009131 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9132 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9133 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9134 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9135 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9136 provides very important information.
9137
9138 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9139 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9140 error logs.
9141
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009142 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009143 logging.
9144
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009145
9146option logasap
9147no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009148 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9150 yes | yes | yes | no
9151 Arguments : none
9152
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009153 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9154 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9155 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9156 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9157
9158 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9159 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9160 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9161 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9162 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009163 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009164 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9165 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9166 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9167 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009168 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009169
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009170 Examples :
9171 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9172 mode http
9173 option httplog
9174 option logasap
9175 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9176
9177 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9178 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9179 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9180 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9181
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009182 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009183 logging.
9184
9185
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009186option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009187 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9189 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009190 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009191 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9192 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009193 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9194 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009195
9196 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9197 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009198 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009199 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009200 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9201 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9202 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009203
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009204 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9205 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9206 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009207
9208 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009209 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009210 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9211 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9212 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9213 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9214 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9215 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9216 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9217
9218 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9219 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009220
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009221 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009222
9223 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9224 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9225 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9226 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009227 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009228 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009229
9230 See also: "option httpchk"
9231
9232
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009233option nolinger
9234no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009235 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009236 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9237 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009238 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009239
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009240 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009241 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9242 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9243 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9244 connections.
9245
9246 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9247 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009248 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9249 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9250 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9251 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9252 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9253 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9254 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9255 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9256 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9257 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9258 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9259 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9260 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009261
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009262 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9263 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9264 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9265 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9266 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009267
9268 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9269 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009270 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009271 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009272 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009273
9274 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9275 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9276
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009277 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9278 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009279
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009280option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9281 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9283 yes | yes | yes | yes
9284 Arguments :
9285 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9286 matching <network>
9287 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9288 header name.
9289
9290 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9291 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9292 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9293 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9294 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9295 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9296 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9297 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9298 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9299 possible that the client has already brought one.
9300
9301 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9302 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9303 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9304 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9305 header and requires different one.
9306
9307 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9308 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9309 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009310 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9311 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9312 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9313 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9314 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009315
9316 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9317 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9318 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9319 both are defined.
9320
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009321 Examples :
9322 # Original Destination address
9323 frontend www
9324 mode http
9325 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9326
9327 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9328 backend www
9329 mode http
9330 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9331
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009332 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009333
9334
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009335option persist
9336no option persist
9337 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9338 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9339 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009340 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009341
9342 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9343 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9344 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9345 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9346 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9347 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9348 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9349 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9350 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9351 redirected to another valid server.
9352
9353 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9354 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9355
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009356 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009357
9358
Christopher Faulet36136e52022-10-03 15:00:59 +02009359option pgsql-check user <username>
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009360 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9362 yes | no | yes | yes
9363 Arguments :
9364 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9365 PostgreSQL server.
9366
9367 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9368 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9369 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9370 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9371
9372 See also: "option httpchk"
9373
9374
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009375option prefer-last-server
9376no option prefer-last-server
9377 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9378 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9379 yes | no | yes | yes
9380 Arguments : none
9381
9382 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009383 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009384 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9385 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009386 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009387 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009388 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009389 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9390 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009391 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009392 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009393 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9394 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9395 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009396 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9397 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9398 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009399
9400 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9401 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9402
9403 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9404
9405
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009406option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009407option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009408no option redispatch
9409 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9410 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9411 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009412 Arguments :
9413 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9414 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9415 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009416 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009417 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009418 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009419 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9420 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9421 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9422
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009423
9424 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9425 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9426 be able to access the service anymore.
9427
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009428 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9429 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009430
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009431 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9432 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9433 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9434 following order:
9435
9436 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9437
9438 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9439 list, or
9440
9441 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9442
9443 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9444 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9445
9446 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9447 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9448 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9449 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9450
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009451 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009452 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9453 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009454
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009455 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9456 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9457
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009458 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009459
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009460
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009461option redis-check
9462 Use redis health checks for server testing
9463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9464 yes | no | yes | yes
9465 Arguments : none
9466
9467 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9468 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9469 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9470 find the "+PONG" response message.
9471
9472 Example :
9473 option redis-check
9474
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009475 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009476
9477
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009478option smtpchk
9479option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9480 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9481 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9482 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009483 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009484 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009485 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009486 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9487
9488 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9489 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9490 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9491
9492 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9493 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9494 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9495 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9496 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9497 dead server.
9498
9499 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9500 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009501 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009502 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9503
9504 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9505 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9506 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9507 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009508 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009509
9510 Example :
9511 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9512
9513 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9514
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009515
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009516option socket-stats
9517no option socket-stats
9518
9519 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9521 yes | yes | yes | no
9522
9523 Arguments : none
9524
9525
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009526option splice-auto
9527no option splice-auto
9528 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9530 yes | yes | yes | yes
9531 Arguments : none
9532
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009533 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009534 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009535 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009536 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009537 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009538 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9539 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9540 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9541 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9542
9543 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9544 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9545 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9546 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9547 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9548 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9549 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9550 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9551 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9552 keyword.
9553
9554 Example :
9555 option splice-auto
9556
9557 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9558 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9559
9560 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9561 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9562
9563
9564option splice-request
9565no option splice-request
9566 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9568 yes | yes | yes | yes
9569 Arguments : none
9570
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009571 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009572 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009573 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9574 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9575 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9576 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9577
9578 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9579
9580 Example :
9581 option splice-request
9582
9583 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9584 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9585
9586 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9587 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9588
9589
9590option splice-response
9591no option splice-response
9592 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9594 yes | yes | yes | yes
9595 Arguments : none
9596
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009597 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009598 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009599 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9600 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9601 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9602 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9603
9604 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9605
9606 Example :
9607 option splice-response
9608
9609 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9610 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9611
9612 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9613 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9614
9615
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009616option spop-check
9617 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9619 no | no | no | yes
9620 Arguments : none
9621
9622 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9623 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9624 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9625 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9626
9627 Example :
9628 option spop-check
9629
9630 See also : "option httpchk"
9631
9632
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009633option srvtcpka
9634no option srvtcpka
9635 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9637 yes | no | yes | yes
9638 Arguments : none
9639
9640 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9641 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009642 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009643 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9644
9645 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9646 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9647 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9648 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9649
9650 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9651 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9652 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9653 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9654 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9655
9656 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9657
9658 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9659 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9660 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9661
9662 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9663 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9664
9665 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9666
9667
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009668option ssl-hello-chk
9669 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9670 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9671 yes | no | yes | yes
9672 Arguments : none
9673
9674 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9675 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9676 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9677 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9678 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9679 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9680 hello message.
9681
9682 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9683 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9684 messages, which is appreciable.
9685
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009686 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009687 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9688 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009689
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009690 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9691
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009692
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009693option tcp-check
9694 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9695 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9696 yes | no | yes | yes
9697
9698 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9699 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9700
9701 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9702 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9703 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9704
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009705 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009706 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9707 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9708 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9709 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9710 only.
9711
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009712 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009713 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009714 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9715 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9716 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9717
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009718 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009719 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9720 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009721 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009722 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9723 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9724 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9725 the respective protocols.
9726 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009727 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009728
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009729 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009730
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009731 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9732 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9733 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9734 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009735
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009736 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9737 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9738 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009739
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009740
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009741 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009742 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009743 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009744 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009745
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009746 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009747 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009748 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009749
9750 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9751 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009752 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009753 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009754 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009755 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009756 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009757 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009758 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9759 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009760 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009761 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9762 tcp-check expect string +OK
9763
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009764 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009765 (send many headers before analyzing)
9766 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009767 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009768 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9769 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9770 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9771 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009772 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009773
9774
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009775 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009776
9777
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009778option tcp-smart-accept
9779no option tcp-smart-accept
9780 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9782 yes | yes | yes | no
9783 Arguments : none
9784
9785 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9786 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9787 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9788 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9789 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9790 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9791
9792 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9793 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9794 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9795 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9796
9797 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9798 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9799 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009800 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009801
9802 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9803 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9804 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9805
9806 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9807 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9808 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9809
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009810 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9811
9812
9813option tcp-smart-connect
9814no option tcp-smart-connect
9815 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9817 yes | no | yes | yes
9818 Arguments : none
9819
9820 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9821 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9822 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9823 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9824 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9825
9826 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9827 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9828 complex.
9829
9830 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9831 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9832 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9833
9834 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9835 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9836
9837 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9838
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009839
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009840option tcpka
9841 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9843 yes | yes | yes | yes
9844 Arguments : none
9845
9846 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9847 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009848 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009849 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9850
9851 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9852 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9853 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9854 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9855
9856 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9857 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9858 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9859 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9860 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9861
9862 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9863
9864 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9865 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9866 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9867 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9868 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9869 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9870 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9871 backends.
9872
9873 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9874
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009875
9876option tcplog
9877 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009879 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009880 Arguments : none
9881
9882 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9883 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9884 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9885 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9886 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9887 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9888 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9889 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9890
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009891 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9892
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009893 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009894
9895
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009896option transparent
9897no option transparent
9898 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009900 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009901 Arguments : none
9902
9903 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9904 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9905 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9906 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9907 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9908 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9909 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9910 appropriate server.
9911
9912 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9913 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9914
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009915 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009916 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009917
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009918
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009919external-check command <command>
9920 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9922 yes | no | yes | yes
9923
9924 Arguments :
9925 <command> is the external command to run
9926
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009927 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9928
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009929 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009930
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009931 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9932 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9933 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9934 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9935 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9936 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009937
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009938 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9939
9940 Environment variables :
9941 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9942 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9943
9944 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9945
9946 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9947
9948 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9949 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9950 for a UNIX socket).
9951
9952 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9953
9954 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9955
9956 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9957
9958 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9959
9960 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9961
9962 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9963 socket).
9964
9965 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9966 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9967
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009968 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9969
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009970 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9971 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9972 failed.
9973
9974 Example :
9975 external-check command /bin/true
9976
9977 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9978
9979
9980external-check path <path>
9981 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9983 yes | no | yes | yes
9984
9985 Arguments :
9986 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9987
9988 The default path is "".
9989
9990 Example :
9991 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9992
9993 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9994 "external-check command"
9995
9996
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009997persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009998persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009999 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
10000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10001 yes | no | yes | yes
10002 Arguments :
10003 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010004 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
10005 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010006
10007 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
10008 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010009 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010010 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
10011 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
10012 forwarded to this server.
10013
10014 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
10015 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
10016 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010017 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010018 a single "listen" section.
10019
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010020 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
10021 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
10022 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
10023
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010024 Example :
10025 listen tse-farm
10026 bind :3389
10027 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10028 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10029 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10030 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10031 persist rdp-cookie
10032 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010033 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010034 balance rdp-cookie
10035 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10036 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
10037
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010010038 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010039
10040
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010041rate-limit sessions <rate>
10042 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
10043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10044 yes | yes | yes | no
10045 Arguments :
10046 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
10047 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
10048
10049 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
10050 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
10051 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010052 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010053 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
10054 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
10055
10056 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
10057 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
10058 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
10059 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
10060
10061 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
10062 listen smtp
10063 mode tcp
10064 bind :25
10065 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020010066 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010067
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020010068 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
10069 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
10070 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010071
10072 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
10073
10074
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010075redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10076redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10077redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010078 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
10079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10080 no | yes | yes | yes
10081
10082 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010010083 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010084
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010085 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010086 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010087 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
10088 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
10089 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010090
10091 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
10092 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
10093 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
10094 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
10095 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010096 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10097 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10098 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10099 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010100
10101 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10102 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10103 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10104 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10105 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10106 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010107 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010108 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010109 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10110 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10111 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010112
10113 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010114 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10115 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10116 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010117 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010118 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10119 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10120 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10121 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010122
10123 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010124 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010125
10126 - "drop-query"
10127 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10128 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10129 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10130 with a location-type redirect.
10131
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010132 - "append-slash"
10133 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10134 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10135 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10136 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10137
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010138 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10139 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10140 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10141 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10142 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10143 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10144 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10145
10146 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10147 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10148 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10149 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10150 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10151 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10152 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010153
10154 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10155 acl clear dst_port 80
10156 acl secure dst_port 8080
10157 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010158 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010159 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010160 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10161
10162 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010163 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10164 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10165 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010166 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010167
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010168 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10169 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10170 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10171
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010172 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010173 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010174
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010175 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010176 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10177 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10178 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010179
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010180 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010181
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010182
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010183retries <value>
10184 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10185 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10186 yes | no | yes | yes
10187 Arguments :
10188 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10189 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10190 default value is 3.
10191
10192 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10193 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10194 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10195
10196 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010197 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10198 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010199
10200 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10201 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10202
10203 See also : "option redispatch"
10204
10205
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010206retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010207 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10208 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10209 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010210 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10211 yes | no | yes | yes
10212 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010213 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
10214 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
10215 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
10216 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
10217 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010218
10219 none never retry
10220
10221 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10222 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10223
10224 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10225 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10226 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10227 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10228 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10229 processing the request.
10230
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010231 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10232 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10233 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10234 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10235 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10236 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10237 overflow attack for example).
10238
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010239 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10240 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10241 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10242 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10243 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10244 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10245 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10246 amplify denial of service attacks.
10247
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010248 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10249 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10250 considered to be safe to retry.
10251
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010252 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10253 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10254 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10255 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10256 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010257
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010258 all-retryable-errors
10259 retry request for any error that are considered
10260 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10261 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10262 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10263
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010264 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10265 not cumulative.
10266
10267 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10268 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10269 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10270 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10271
10272 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10273 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10274 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10275 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10276 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10277 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10278 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10279 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10280 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10281 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10282 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10283 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10284
10285 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10286 should not use this directive.
10287
10288 The default is "conn-failure".
10289
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010290 Example:
10291 retry-on 503 504
10292
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010293 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10294
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010295server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010296 Declare a server in a backend
10297 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10298 no | no | yes | yes
10299 Arguments :
10300 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010301 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010302 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010303
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010304 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10305 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10306 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10307 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010308 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10309 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010310 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010311 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10312 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010313 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10314 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10315 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10316 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10317 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10318 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10319 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010320 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010321 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10322 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10323 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10324 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10325 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10326 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010327 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10328 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010329 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10330 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010331
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010332 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010333 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10334 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10335 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10336 adding this value to the client's port.
10337
10338 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10339 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010340 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010341
10342 Examples :
10343 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10344 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010345 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010346 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10347 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10348 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010349
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010350 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10351 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10352 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10353 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10354 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10355
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010356 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10357 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010358
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010359server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010360 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010361 this backend.
10362 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10363 no | no | yes | yes
10364
10365 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10366 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10367 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10368 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10369 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010370
10371 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10372 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10373
10374 global
10375 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10376
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010377 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010378 load-server-state-from-file
10379
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010380 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010381 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010382
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010383server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10384 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10385 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10387 no | no | yes | yes
10388
10389 Arguments:
10390 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10391
10392 <num | range>
10393 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10394 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10395 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10396 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10397
10398 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10399
10400 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10401
10402 <params*>
10403 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10404 keyword.
10405
10406 Examples:
10407 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10408 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10409 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10410
10411 # or
10412 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10413
10414 # would be equivalent to:
10415 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10416 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10417 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10418
10419
10420
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010421source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010422source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010423source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010424 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10426 yes | no | yes | yes
10427 Arguments :
10428 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10429 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010430
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010431 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010432 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10433 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10434 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10435 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10436 supported prefixes are :
10437 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10438 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10439 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010440 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010441 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10442 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010443
10444 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10445 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010446 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10447 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10448 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010449
10450 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10451 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10452 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10453 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10454 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10455 <addr>.
10456
10457 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10458 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10459 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10460 port.
10461
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010462 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10463 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10464 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10465 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010466 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010467 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10468 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10469 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10470 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10471 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10472 HTTP header.
10473
10474 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10475 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010476 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010477 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10478 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10479 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10480 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10481 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10482 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10483 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10484
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010485 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10486 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10487 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10488 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10489 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10490 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10491
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010492 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10493 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10494 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10495 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10496
10497 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10498 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10499 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10500 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10501 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10502 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10503
10504 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10505 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10506 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10507 there are two methods :
10508
10509 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10510 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10511 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10512 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10513 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10514 of the client ranges may be used.
10515
10516 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10517 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10518 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10519 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10520 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10521 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10522 same session.
10523
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010524 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10525 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10526 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010527 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010528
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010529 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10530
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010531 Examples :
10532 backend private
10533 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10534 source 192.168.1.200
10535
10536 backend transparent_ssl1
10537 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10538 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10539
10540 backend transparent_ssl2
10541 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10542 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10543 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10544
10545 backend transparent_ssl3
10546 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10547 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10548 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10549
10550 backend transparent_smtp
10551 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10552 # with Tproxy version 4.
10553 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10554
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010555 backend transparent_http
10556 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10557 # proxy.
10558 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10559
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010560 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010561 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10562
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010563
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010564srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10565 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10566 the connection on the server side.
10567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10568 yes | no | yes | yes
10569 Arguments :
10570 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10571
10572 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10573 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010574 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10575 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010576
10577 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10578
10579
10580srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10581 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10582 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10583 server side.
10584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10585 yes | no | yes | yes
10586 Arguments :
10587 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10588 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10589 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10590 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10591
10592 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10593 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010594 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10595 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010596
10597 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10598
10599
10600srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10601 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10603 yes | no | yes | yes
10604 Arguments :
10605 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10606 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10607 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10608 document.
10609
10610 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10611 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010612 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10613 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010614
10615 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10616
10617
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010618stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10619 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010621 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010622
10623 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10624 matched.
10625
10626 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10627 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10628
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010629 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10630 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010631 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010632
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010633 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10634 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10635 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10636 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010637
10638 Example :
10639 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10640 backend stats_localhost
10641 stats enable
10642 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10643
10644 Example :
10645 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10646 backend stats_auth
10647 stats enable
10648 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10649 stats admin if TRUE
10650
10651 Example :
10652 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10653 userlist stats-auth
10654 group admin users admin
10655 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10656 group readonly users haproxy
10657 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10658
10659 backend stats_auth
10660 stats enable
10661 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10662 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10663 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10664 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10665
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010666 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10667 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10668 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010669
10670
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010671stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10672 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010674 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010675 Arguments :
10676 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10677
10678 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10679
10680 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10681 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10682 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10683 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10684 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10685 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10686
10687 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10688 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10689 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010690 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010691
10692 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10693 report using "stats scope".
10694
10695 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10696 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10697 unobvious parameters.
10698
10699 Example :
10700 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10701 backend public_www
10702 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10703 stats enable
10704 stats hide-version
10705 stats scope .
10706 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010707 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010708 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10709 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10710
10711 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10712 backend private_monitoring
10713 stats enable
10714 stats uri /admin?stats
10715 stats refresh 5s
10716
10717 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10718
10719
10720stats enable
10721 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010723 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010724 Arguments : none
10725
10726 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10727 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10728 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10729 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10730 - stats auth : no authentication
10731 - stats scope : no restriction
10732
10733 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10734 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10735 unobvious parameters.
10736
10737 Example :
10738 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10739 backend public_www
10740 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10741 stats enable
10742 stats hide-version
10743 stats scope .
10744 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010745 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010746 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10747 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10748
10749 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10750 backend private_monitoring
10751 stats enable
10752 stats uri /admin?stats
10753 stats refresh 5s
10754
10755 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10756
10757
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010758stats hide-version
10759 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010761 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010762 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010763
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010764 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10765 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10766 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10767 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10768 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10769 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010770
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010771 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10772 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10773 unobvious parameters.
10774
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010775 Example :
10776 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10777 backend public_www
10778 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010779 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010780 stats hide-version
10781 stats scope .
10782 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010783 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010784 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10785 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010786
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010787 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10788 backend private_monitoring
10789 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010790 stats uri /admin?stats
10791 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010792
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010793 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010794
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010795
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010796stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10797 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10798 Access control for statistics
10799
10800 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10801 no | no | yes | yes
10802
10803 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10804 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10805 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10806 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10807 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10808 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10809
10810 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10811 instance.
10812
10813 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10814 about ACL usage.
10815
10816
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010817stats realm <realm>
10818 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010820 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010821 Arguments :
10822 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10823 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10824 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10825
10826 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10827 using a backslash ('\').
10828
10829 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10830 only related to authentication.
10831
10832 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10833 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10834 unobvious parameters.
10835
10836 Example :
10837 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10838 backend public_www
10839 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10840 stats enable
10841 stats hide-version
10842 stats scope .
10843 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010844 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010845 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10846 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10847
10848 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10849 backend private_monitoring
10850 stats enable
10851 stats uri /admin?stats
10852 stats refresh 5s
10853
10854 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10855
10856
10857stats refresh <delay>
10858 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010860 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010861 Arguments :
10862 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10863 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10864 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10865 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10866 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10867 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10868
10869 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10870 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10871 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010872 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010873
10874 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10875 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10876 unobvious parameters.
10877
10878 Example :
10879 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10880 backend public_www
10881 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10882 stats enable
10883 stats hide-version
10884 stats scope .
10885 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010886 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010887 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10888 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10889
10890 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10891 backend private_monitoring
10892 stats enable
10893 stats uri /admin?stats
10894 stats refresh 5s
10895
10896 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10897
10898
10899stats scope { <name> | "." }
10900 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010902 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010903 Arguments :
10904 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10905 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10906 section in which the statement appears.
10907
10908 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10909 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10910 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10911 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10912 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10913 exists.
10914
10915 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10916 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10917 unobvious parameters.
10918
10919 Example :
10920 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10921 backend public_www
10922 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10923 stats enable
10924 stats hide-version
10925 stats scope .
10926 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010927 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010928 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10929 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10930
10931 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10932 backend private_monitoring
10933 stats enable
10934 stats uri /admin?stats
10935 stats refresh 5s
10936
10937 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10938
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010939
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010940stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010941 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010943 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010944
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010945 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010946 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10947
10948 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10949 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10950
10951 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10952 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010953 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010954
10955 Example :
10956 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10957 backend private_monitoring
10958 stats enable
10959 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10960 stats uri /admin?stats
10961 stats refresh 5s
10962
10963 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10964 global section.
10965
10966
10967stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010968 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10970 yes | yes | yes | yes
10971 Arguments : none
10972
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010973 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010974 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10975 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10976 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10977 - IP (socket, server)
10978 - cookie (backend, server)
10979
10980 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10981 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010982 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010983
10984 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10985
10986
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010987stats show-modules
10988 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10990 yes | yes | yes | yes
10991 Arguments : none
10992
10993 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10994 values as a tooltip.
10995
10996 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10997 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10998 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10999
11000 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11001
11002
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011003stats show-node [ <name> ]
11004 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
11005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011006 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011007 Arguments:
11008 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
11009 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
11010
11011 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11012 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011013 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011014
11015 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11016 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11017 unobvious parameters.
11018
11019 Example:
11020 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11021 backend private_monitoring
11022 stats enable
11023 stats show-node Europe-1
11024 stats uri /admin?stats
11025 stats refresh 5s
11026
11027 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
11028 section.
11029
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011030
11031stats uri <prefix>
11032 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
11033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011034 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011035 Arguments :
11036 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
11037 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
11038 query string.
11039
11040 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
11041 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
11042 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
11043 possible to reach it in the application.
11044
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011045 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011046 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011047 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
11048 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
11049 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
11050 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
11051
11052 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
11053 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
11054 an address or a port to statistics only.
11055
11056 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11057 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11058 unobvious parameters.
11059
11060 Example :
11061 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11062 backend public_www
11063 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11064 stats enable
11065 stats hide-version
11066 stats scope .
11067 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011068 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011069 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11070 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11071
11072 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11073 backend private_monitoring
11074 stats enable
11075 stats uri /admin?stats
11076 stats refresh 5s
11077
11078 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
11079
11080
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011081stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
11082 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011084 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011085
11086 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011087 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011088 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011089 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011090 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
11091
11092 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11093 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11094 the "stick-table" statement.
11095
11096 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11097 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11098 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11099 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11100 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11101
11102 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11103 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11104 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11105 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11106 transformation rules.
11107
11108 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11109 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11110 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11111 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11112 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11113 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11114 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11115
11116 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11117 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11118 ACL based conditions.
11119
11120 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11121 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11122 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11123 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11124
11125 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11126 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11127 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11128 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11129
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011130 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11131 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011132 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011133
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011134 Example :
11135 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11136 # last 30 minutes
11137 backend pop
11138 mode tcp
11139 balance roundrobin
11140 stick store-request src
11141 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11142 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11143 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11144
11145 backend smtp
11146 mode tcp
11147 balance roundrobin
11148 stick match src table pop
11149 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11150 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11151
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011152 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011153 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011154
11155
11156stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11157 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11159 no | no | yes | yes
11160
11161 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11162 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11163 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11164 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11165
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011166 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11167 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011168 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011169
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011170 Examples :
11171 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011172 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011173
11174 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11175 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11176 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11177
11178
11179 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11180 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11181 backend http
11182 mode http
11183 balance roundrobin
11184 stick on src table https
11185 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11186 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11187 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11188
11189 backend https
11190 mode tcp
11191 balance roundrobin
11192 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11193 stick on src
11194 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11195 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11196
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011197 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011198
11199
11200stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11201 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11203 no | no | yes | yes
11204
11205 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011206 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011207 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011208 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011209 server is selected.
11210
11211 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11212 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11213 the "stick-table" statement.
11214
11215 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11216 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11217 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11218 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11219 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11220 address.
11221
11222 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11223 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11224 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11225 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11226 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11227 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11228 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11229 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11230 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11231 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11232
11233 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11234 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11235 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11236 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11237 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11238 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11239 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11240
11241 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11242 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11243 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11244 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11245
11246 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11247 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11248 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11249 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11250 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11251 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011252 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11253 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11254 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11255 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11256 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11257 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011258
11259 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11260 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11261 the request.
11262
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011263 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11264 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011265 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011266
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011267 Example :
11268 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11269 # last 30 minutes
11270 backend pop
11271 mode tcp
11272 balance roundrobin
11273 stick store-request src
11274 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11275 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11276 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11277
11278 backend smtp
11279 mode tcp
11280 balance roundrobin
11281 stick match src table pop
11282 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11283 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11284
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011285 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011286 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011287
11288
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011289stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011290 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011291 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011292 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011294 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011295
11296 Arguments :
11297 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11298 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11299 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11300 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11301
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011302 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11303 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11304 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11305 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11306
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011307 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11308 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11309 instance.
11310
11311 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11312 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11313 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11314 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11315 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11316 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011317 to 32 characters.
11318
11319 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11320 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11321 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011322 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011323 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11324 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011325
11326 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011327 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11328 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011329 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11330 increase.
11331
11332 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011333 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11334 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11335 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011336
11337 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011338 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011339 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11340 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011341 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011342 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11343 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11344 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11345 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11346 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11347 parameter (see below).
11348
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011349 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11350 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11351 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11352 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11353 soft restart.
11354
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020011355 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
11356 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011357
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011358 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
Emeric Brunad57d202022-05-30 18:08:28 +020011359 was last created, refreshed using 'track-sc' or matched using
11360 'stick match' or 'stick on' rule. The expiration delay is
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011361 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11362 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011363 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011364 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011365 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11366 if not expiration delay is specified.
Emeric Brunad57d202022-05-30 18:08:28 +020011367 Note: 'table_*' converters performs lookups but won't update touch
11368 expire since they don't require 'track-sc'.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011369
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011370 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11371 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11372 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11373 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11374 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11375 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11376 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11377 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11378 token.
11379
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011380 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11381 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11382 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11383 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011384 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11385 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11386 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11387 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11388 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11389 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11390 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11391 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11392 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11393 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11394 types and their arguments.
11395
11396 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11397 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11398 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11399 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11400
11401 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11402 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11403 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011404 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011405
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011406 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11407 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11408 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011409 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011410 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011411 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011412
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011413 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11414 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11415 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11416 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11417
11418 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11419 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11420 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11421 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11422 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11423 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11424
Emeric Bruna5d15312021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011425 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11426 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11427 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11428 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11429
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011430 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11431 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11432 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11433 they were received.
11434
11435 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11436 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11437 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11438 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11439 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11440
11441 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11442 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11443 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11444 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11445 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11446
11447 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11448 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11449 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11450
11451 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11452 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11453 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11454 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11455 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11456
11457 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11458 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11459 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11460 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11461 the client side.
11462
11463 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11464 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11465 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11466 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11467 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11468 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11469 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11470
11471 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11472 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11473 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11474 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11475 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11476 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011477 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011478
11479 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11480 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11481 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11482 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11483 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11484 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11485
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011486 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11487 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11488 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11489 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11490 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11491
11492 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11493 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11494 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11495 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11496 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11497 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11498
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011499 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011500 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011501 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11502 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11503
11504 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11505 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11506 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11507 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11508 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11509 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11510 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11511 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11512 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11513 recommended for better fairness.
11514
11515 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011516 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011517 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11518 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11519
11520 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11521 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11522 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11523 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11524 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11525 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11526 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11527 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11528 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11529 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011530
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011531 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11532 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011533 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11534 reference it.
11535
11536 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11537 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011538 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11539 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11540 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011541
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011542 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11543 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11544 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11545 something that can be ignored.
11546
11547 Example:
11548 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11549 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11550 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11551 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11552
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011553 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011554 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011555
11556
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011557stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011558 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11560 no | no | yes | yes
11561
11562 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011563 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011564 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011565 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011566 server is selected.
11567
11568 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11569 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11570 the "stick-table" statement.
11571
11572 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11573 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11574 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11575 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11576
11577 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11578 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11579 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11580 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11581 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11582 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011583 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011584 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11585 rules.
11586
11587 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11588 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11589 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11590 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11591 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11592 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11593 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11594
11595 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11596 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11597 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11598 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11599
11600 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11601 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11602 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11603 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11604 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11605 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011606 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11607 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11608 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11609 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11610 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11611 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11612 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11613 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11614 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011615
11616 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11617
11618 Example :
11619 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11620 backend https
11621 mode tcp
11622 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011623 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011624 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011625
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011626 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
11627 acl serverhello rep.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011628
11629 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11630 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11631 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11632
11633 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11634 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011635
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011636 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11637 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11638 # at offset 44.
11639
11640 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011641 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011642
11643 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011644 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011645
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011646 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11647 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11648
11649 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11650 extraction.
11651
11652
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011653tcp-check comment <string>
11654 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11655 it fails.
11656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11657 yes | no | yes | yes
11658
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011659 Arguments :
11660 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11661 rule fails.
11662
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011663 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11664 user-friendly error reporting.
11665
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011666 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11667 "tcp-check expect".
11668
11669
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011670tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11671 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011672 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011673 Opens a new connection
11674 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011675 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011676
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011677 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011678 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11679
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011680 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011681 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011682
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011683 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011684 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11685 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011686 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011687
11688 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011689
11690 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11691
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011692 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11693
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011694 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11695
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011696 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11697
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011698 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11699 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11700 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11701 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11702
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011703 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11704 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11705 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11706 haproxy -vv.
11707
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011708 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011709
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011710 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11711 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11712 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11713
11714 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11715 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11716 of the sequence.
11717
11718 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11719 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11720 do.
11721
11722 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11723 unset-var or comment rules.
11724
11725 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011726 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11727 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11728 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11729 option tcp-check
11730 tcp-check connect
11731 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11732 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11733 tcp-check send \r\n
11734 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11735 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11736 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11737 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11738 tcp-check send \r\n
11739 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11740 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11741
11742 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11743 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011744 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011745 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11746 tcp-check connect port 143
11747 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11748 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11749
11750 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11751
11752
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011753tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011754 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011755 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011756 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011757 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011758 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011759 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011760
11761 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011762 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11763
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011764 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11765 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11766 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11767 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11768 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11769 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11770 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11771 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11772 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11773 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11774
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011775 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011776 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11777 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011778 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11779 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11780 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11781
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011782 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11783 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11784 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011785 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11786 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011787 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11788 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011789 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11790 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011791 By default "L7OK" is used.
11792
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011793 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11794 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011795 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11796 supported :
11797 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11798 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011799 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11800 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11801 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11802 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11803 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011804
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011805 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011806 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011807 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11808 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11809 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11810 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011811 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11812
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011813 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11814 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11815 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11816 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11817
11818 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11819 informational message reported in logs if an error
11820 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11821 log-format string.
11822
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011823 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11824 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11825 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11826 followed by some converters.
11827
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011828 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11829 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11830 with the usual backslash ('\').
11831 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011832 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011833 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11834 used upper or lower case.
11835
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011836 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11837
11838 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11839 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11840 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11841 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11842 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11843 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11844 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11845 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11846
11847 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11848 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11849 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11850 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11851 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11852 expression.
11853
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011854 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11855 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11856 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11857 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11858 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11859 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11860
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011861 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11862 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11863 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11864 this exact hexadecimal string.
11865 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11866
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011867 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11868 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11869 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11870 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11871 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11872 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11873 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11874 size.
11875
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011876 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11877 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11878 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11879 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11880 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11881 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11882 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11883 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11884 in a binary string before matching the response's
11885 buffer.
11886
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011887 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011888 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011889 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11890 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11891 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11892 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11893 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11894 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11895 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11896 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11897 the null character.
11898
11899 Examples :
11900 # perform a POP check
11901 option tcp-check
11902 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11903
11904 # perform an IMAP check
11905 option tcp-check
11906 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11907
11908 # look for the redis master server
11909 option tcp-check
11910 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011911 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011912 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11913 tcp-check expect string role:master
11914 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11915 tcp-check expect string +OK
11916
11917
11918 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011919 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011920
11921
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011922tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11923tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11924 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11925 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011926 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011927 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011928
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011929 Arguments :
11930 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11931
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011932 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11933 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011934
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011935 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11936 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011937
11938 Examples :
11939 # look for the redis master server
11940 option tcp-check
11941 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11942 tcp-check expect string role:master
11943
11944 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011945 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011946
11947
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011948tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11949tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11950 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11951 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011952 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011953 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011954
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011955 Arguments :
11956 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011957
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011958 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11959 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011960
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011961 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11962 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11963 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011964
11965 Examples :
11966 # redis check in binary
11967 option tcp-check
11968 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11969 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11970
11971
11972 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011973 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011974
11975
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011976tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011977 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011978 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011979 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011980
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011981 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011982 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11983 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11984 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11985 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11986 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11987 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11988 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11989 and '-'.
11990
11991 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11992
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011993 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011994 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11995
11996
11997tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011998 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011999 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012000 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012001
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012002 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012003 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12004 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12005 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12006 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12007 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12008 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12009 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12010 and '-'.
12011
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012012 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012013 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
12014
12015
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012016tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12017 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12019 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012020 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012021 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12022 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012023
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012024 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012025
12026 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
12027 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012028 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
12029 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
12030 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
12031 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
12032 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
12033 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012034
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012035 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12036 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12037 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
12038 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012039
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012040 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012041 - accept :
12042 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12043 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12044 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012045
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012046 - reject :
12047 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12048 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12049 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
12050 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
12051 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
12052 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
12053 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
12054 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
12055 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
12056 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
12057 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012058 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012059
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012060 - expect-proxy layer4 :
12061 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
12062 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
12063 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
12064 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
12065 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
12066 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
12067 hosts.
12068
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012069 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
12070 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
12071 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
12072 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
12073 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
12074 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
12075 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
12076 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
12077
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012078 - capture <sample> len <length> :
12079 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
12080 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
12081 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
12082 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
12083 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
12084 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
12085 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
12086 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012087 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
12088 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012089
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012090 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012091 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012092 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
12093 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
12094 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012095 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020012096 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012097 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
12098 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
12099 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
12100 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
12101 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
12102 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
12103 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012104
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012105 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012106 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012107 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012108 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012109 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
12110 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
12111 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012112
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012113 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
12114 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
12115 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
12116 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012117
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012118 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
12119 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
12120 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
12121 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
12122 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012123 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
12124 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
12125 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
12126 layer7 information is extracted.
12127
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012128 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
12129 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
12130 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
12131 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
12132 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012133
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012134 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12135 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12136 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12137 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12138
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012139 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12140 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12141 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12142 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12143
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012144 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12145 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12146 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12147 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12148 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012149
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012150 - set-src <expr> :
12151 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
12152 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
12153 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012154 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012155
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012156 Arguments:
12157 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12158 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012159
12160 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012161 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
12162
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012163 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
12164 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012165
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012166 - set-src-port <expr> :
12167 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
12168 expression.
12169
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012170 Arguments:
12171 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12172 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012173
12174 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012175 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
12176
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012177 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
12178 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
12179 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012180
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012181 - set-dst <expr> :
12182 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
12183 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
12184 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
12185 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12186 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12187
12188 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12189 followed by some converters.
12190
12191 Example:
12192
12193 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
12194 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
12195
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012196 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12197 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12198
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012199 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12200 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12201 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12202 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12203
12204
12205 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12206 followed by some converters.
12207
12208 Example:
12209
12210 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12211
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012212 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12213 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12214 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12215
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012216 - "silent-drop" :
12217 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012218 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012219 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12220 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12221 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12222 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12223 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012224 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12225 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012226 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12227 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012228 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012229 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12230 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12231 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12232 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12233
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012234 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12235 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12236 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012237
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012238 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12239 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12240 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012241
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012242 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012243 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012244 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012245
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012246 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12247 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12248 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012249
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012250 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012251 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12252 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012253
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012254 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12255
12256 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12257
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012258 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12259
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012260 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012261
12262
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012263tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12264 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012266 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012267 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012268 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12269 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012270
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012271 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012272
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012273 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012274 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12275 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012276 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12277 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012278
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012279 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12280 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12281 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12282 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012283 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012284 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012285 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12286 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12287 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12288 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012289 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012290 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012291
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012292 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12293 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12294 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12295 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012296
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012297 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012298 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012299 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012300 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12301 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012302 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012303 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012304 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012305 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012306 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012307 - set-dst <expr>
12308 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012309 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012310 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012311 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012312 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012313 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012314 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012315
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012316 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12317 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012318 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12319 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012320
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012321 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12322 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12323 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12324 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12325 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12326 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012327
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012328 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012329 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12330 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012331
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012332 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12333 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12334 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12335 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12336 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12337 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12338
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012339 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012340 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12341 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12342 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12343 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12344 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12345 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12346 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12347 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12348 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12349 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012350
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012351 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012352 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12353 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12354 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012355
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012356 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12357 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12358
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012359 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012360 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12361 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012362
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012363 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12364 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012365 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012366 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12367 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012368 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012369 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012370 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012371 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12372 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012373 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012374 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12375 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012376
12377 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12378 followed by some converters.
12379
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012380 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012381 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12382 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12383 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12384 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12385 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12386 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsin3df59892021-05-10 12:50:00 +050012387 warning. These directives will be conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012388 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12389 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12390
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012391 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12392
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012393 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12394 <var-name>.
12395
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012396 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12397 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12398 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12399 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12400 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12401
12402 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12403 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12404 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12405 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12406 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12407 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12408 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12409 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12410 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12411 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12412 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12413
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012414 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12415 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12416 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12417 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12418 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12419
12420 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12421
12422 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12423
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012424 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12425 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12426 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12427 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12428 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12429 evaluated.
12430
12431 Example:
Aurelien DARRAGONdf332122022-10-05 18:09:33 +020012432 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012433
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012434 Example:
12435
12436 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012437 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012438
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012439 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012440 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012441 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012442 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12443 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012444 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012445 tcp-request content reject
12446
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012447 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12448 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12449 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12450 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12451 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12452 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12453 ...
12454 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12455
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012456 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012457 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12458 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012459 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012460 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012461
12462 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12463 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012464 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012465 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012466 tcp-request content reject
12467
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012468 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012469 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012470 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012471 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012472 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12473 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012474
12475 Example:
12476 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12477 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012478 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012479
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012480 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012481 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012482
12483 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012484 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012485 # protecting all our sites
12486 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012487 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12488 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012489 ...
12490 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12491
12492 backend http_dynamic
12493 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012494 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012495 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012496 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012497 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012498 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012499 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012500
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012501 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012502
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012503 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12504 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012505
12506
12507tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12508 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012510 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012511 Arguments :
12512 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12513 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12514 as explained at the top of this document.
12515
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012516 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012517 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12518 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12519 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12520 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12521
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012522 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12523 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12524 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12525 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12526
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012527 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012528 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012529 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012530 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012531 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012532 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12533 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12534 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012535
12536 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12537 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12538 it pass through unaffected.
12539
12540 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12541 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12542 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012543 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012544 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12545 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012546 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12547 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12548 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012549
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012550 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012551 "timeout client".
12552
12553
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012554tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12555 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12557 no | no | yes | yes
12558 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012559 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12560 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012561
12562 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12563
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012564 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012565 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12566 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012567 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12568 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012569
12570 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12571
12572 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12573 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12574 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12575 inserted.
12576
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012577 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012578 - accept :
12579 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12580 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12581 the rules evaluation.
12582
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012583 - close :
12584 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12585 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12586 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12587 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12588 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12589 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012590 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012591 protocols.
12592
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012593 - reject :
12594 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12595 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012596 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012597
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012598 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau9de54ba2021-09-02 20:51:21 +020012599 Sets a variable from an expression.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012600
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012601 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12602 Unsets a variable.
12603
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012604 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12605 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12606 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12607 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12608
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012609 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12610 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12611 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12612 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12613
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012614 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12615 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12616 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12617 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12618 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012619
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012620 - "silent-drop" :
12621 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012622 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012623 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12624 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12625 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12626 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12627 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012628 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12629 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012630 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12631 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012632 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012633 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12634 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12635 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12636 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12637
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012638 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12639 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12640
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012641 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12642 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12643 for changing the default action to a reject.
12644
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012645 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12646 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12647 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12648 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012649 period.
12650
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012651 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12652 declared inline.
12653
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012654 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12655 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012656 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012657 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12658 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012659 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012660 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012661 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012662 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12663 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012664 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012665 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12666 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012667
12668 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12669 followed by some converters.
12670
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012671 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12672 <var-name>.
12673
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012674 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12675 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12676 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12677 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12678 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12679
12680 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12681
12682 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12683
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012684 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12685
12686 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12687
12688
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012689tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12690 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12692 no | yes | yes | no
12693 Arguments :
12694 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12695 below.
12696
12697 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12698
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012699 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012700 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12701 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12702 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12703 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12704 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12705 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12706 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012707 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012708 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12709 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12710 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12711 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12712 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12713 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12714 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12715 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12716 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12717 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12718 instead.
12719
12720 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12721 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12722 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12723 rules which may be inserted.
12724
12725 Several types of actions are supported :
12726 - accept : the request is accepted
12727 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12728 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12729 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012730 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012731 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet57759f32021-06-23 12:19:25 +020012732 - set-dst <expr>
12733 - set-dst-port <expr>
12734 - set-src <expr>
12735 - set-src-port <expr>
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012736 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012737 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012738 - silent-drop
12739
12740 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12741 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12742 sections for a complete description.
12743
12744 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12745 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12746 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12747
12748 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12749 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12750 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12751 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12752 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12753
12754 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12755 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12756
12757 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12758 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12759 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12760
12761 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12762 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12763 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12764
12765 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12766 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12767 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12768
12769 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12770 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12771 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12772
12773 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12774
12775 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12776
12777
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012778tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12779 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12781 no | no | yes | yes
12782 Arguments :
12783 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12784 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12785 as explained at the top of this document.
12786
12787 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12788
12789
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012790timeout check <timeout>
12791 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12792 established.
12793
12794 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12795 yes | no | yes | yes
12796 Arguments:
12797 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12798 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12799 as explained at the top of this document.
12800
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012801 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012802 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012803 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012804 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012805 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12806 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12807 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012808
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012809 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012810 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12811
12812 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12813 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012814 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012815
12816 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12817 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12818 forget about it.
12819
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012820 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12821 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012822
12823
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012824timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012825 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12827 yes | yes | yes | no
12828 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012829 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012830 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12831 as explained at the top of this document.
12832
12833 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12834 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12835 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012836 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12837 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12838 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12839 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012840 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12841 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12842 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012843 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012844 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012845 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12846 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012847 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12848 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012849
12850 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12851 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12852 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12853 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012854 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012855 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12856
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012857 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012858
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012859
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012860timeout client-fin <timeout>
12861 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12863 yes | yes | yes | no
12864 Arguments :
12865 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12866 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12867 as explained at the top of this document.
12868
12869 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12870 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12871 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12872 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12873 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12874 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12875 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012876 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12877 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12878 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012879
12880 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12881 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12882 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12883
12884 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12885
12886
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012887timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012888 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12890 yes | no | yes | yes
12891 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012892 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012893 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12894 as explained at the top of this document.
12895
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012896 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012897 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012898 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012899 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012900 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12901 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012902
12903 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12904 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12905 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12906 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012907 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012908 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12909
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012910 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012911
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012912
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012913timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12914 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12916 yes | yes | yes | yes
12917 Arguments :
12918 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12919 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12920 as explained at the top of this document.
12921
12922 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12923 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12924 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12925 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12926 once the request has started to present itself.
12927
12928 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12929 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12930 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12931 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12932 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12933
12934 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12935 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12936 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12937 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12938
12939 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12940 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012941 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012942 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12943 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012944 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012945
12946 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12947 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12948 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12949 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12950
12951 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12952
12953
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012954timeout http-request <timeout>
12955 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12956 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012957 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012958 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012959 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012960 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12961 as explained at the top of this document.
12962
12963 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12964 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12965 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12966 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12967 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12968 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12969 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012970 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12971 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12972 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12973 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012974 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012975 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12976 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012977
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012978 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12979 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12980 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12981 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12982 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012983 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012984
12985 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12986 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012987 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012988 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12989 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12990
12991 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012992 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12993 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12994 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012995
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012996 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012997 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012998
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012999
13000timeout queue <timeout>
13001 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
13002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13003 yes | no | yes | yes
13004 Arguments :
13005 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13006 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13007 as explained at the top of this document.
13008
13009 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
13010 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
13011 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
13012 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
13013 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
13014
13015 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
13016 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
13017 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
13018 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
13019
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013020 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013021
13022
13023timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013024 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
13025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13026 yes | no | yes | yes
13027 Arguments :
13028 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13029 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13030 as explained at the top of this document.
13031
13032 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13033 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13034 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13035 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13036 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13037 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13038 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13039
13040 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13041 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13042 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13043 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13044 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013045 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013046 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013047 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13048 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013049 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13050 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013051
13052 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13053 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13054 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13055 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013056 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013057 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13058
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013059 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013060
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013061
13062timeout server-fin <timeout>
13063 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13065 yes | no | yes | yes
13066 Arguments :
13067 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13068 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13069 as explained at the top of this document.
13070
13071 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13072 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13073 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13074 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13075 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13076 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13077 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13078 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13079 situations, it should not be needed.
13080
13081 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13082 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13083 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13084
13085 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13086
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013087
13088timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013089 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13091 yes | yes | yes | yes
13092 Arguments :
13093 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13094 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13095 as explained at the top of this document.
13096
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013097 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13098 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13099 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013100
13101 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13102 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13103 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13104 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013105 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013106
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013107 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013108
13109
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013110timeout tunnel <timeout>
13111 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13113 yes | no | yes | yes
13114 Arguments :
13115 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13116 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13117 as explained at the top of this document.
13118
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013119 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013120 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13121 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13122 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013123 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13124 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013125 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13126 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13127 specified.
13128
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013129 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13130 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13131 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13132 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13133 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13134 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13135 state.
13136
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013137 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13138 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13139 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13140 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013141 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013142
13143 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13144 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13145 forget about it.
13146
13147 Example :
13148 defaults http
13149 option http-server-close
13150 timeout connect 5s
13151 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013152 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013153 timeout server 30s
13154 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13155
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013156 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013157
13158
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013159transparent (deprecated)
13160 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013162 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013163 Arguments : none
13164
13165 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13166 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13167 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13168 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13169 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13170 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13171 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13172 appropriate server.
13173
13174 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13175
13176 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13177 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13178
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013179 See also: "option transparent"
13180
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013181unique-id-format <string>
13182 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13184 yes | yes | yes | no
13185 Arguments :
13186 <string> is a log-format string.
13187
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013188 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13189 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13190 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13191 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013192
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013193 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013194 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013195 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13196 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13197 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13198 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13199 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13200 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013201
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013202 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13203 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013204
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013205 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013206
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013207 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013208
13209 will generate:
13210
13211 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13212
13213 See also: "unique-id-header"
13214
13215unique-id-header <name>
13216 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13218 yes | yes | yes | no
13219 Arguments :
13220 <name> is the name of the header.
13221
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013222 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13223 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013224
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013225 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013226
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013227 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013228 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13229
13230 will generate:
13231
13232 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13233
13234 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013235
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013236use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013237 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13239 no | yes | yes | no
13240 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013241 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13242 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013243
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013244 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13245 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013246
13247 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13248 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13249 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013250 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013251 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013252 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13253 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013254
13255 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13256 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13257 assign the backend.
13258
13259 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13260 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13261 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13262 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13263 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13264 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13265
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013266 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013267 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013268 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13269 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13270 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13271
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013272 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13273 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13274 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13275 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13276 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13277 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13278 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13279 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13280 cannot be forced from the request.
13281
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013282 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013283 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13284 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13285
13286 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13287 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013288
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013289use-fcgi-app <name>
13290 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13292 no | no | yes | yes
13293 Arguments :
13294 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13295
13296 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013297
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013298use-server <server> if <condition>
13299use-server <server> unless <condition>
13300 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13302 no | no | yes | yes
13303 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013304 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13305 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013306
13307 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13308
13309 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13310 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13311 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13312
13313 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13314 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13315 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13316 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13317 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13318 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13319 matches will assign the server.
13320
13321 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13322 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13323 with the next rules until one matches.
13324
13325 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13326 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13327 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13328 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13329
13330 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13331 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13332 stripped.
13333
13334 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13335 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013336 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013337 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013338 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013339
13340 Example :
13341 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013342 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013343 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013344 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013345 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013346 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013347 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013348 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13349 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13350
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013351 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13352 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13353 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13354 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013355 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013356 and we fall back to load balancing.
13357
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013358 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013359
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013360
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133615. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013362--------------------------
13363
13364The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13365depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13366settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13367written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13368described in this section.
13369
13370
133715.1. Bind options
13372-----------------
13373
13374The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13375as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13376no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13377parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13378while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13379provided immediately after the setting name.
13380
13381The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13382
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013383accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13384 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13385 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13386 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13387 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13388 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13389 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13390 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13391 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13392 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013393 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13394 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13395 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013396
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013397accept-proxy
13398 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013399 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13400 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013401 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13402 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13403 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13404 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013405 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013406 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13407 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013408 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13409 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013410
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013411allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013412 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013413 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013414 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013415 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13416 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013417
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013418alpn <protocols>
13419 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13420 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13421 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013422 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013423 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013424 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13425 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13426 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13427 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13428 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13429 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13430 preference, like below :
13431
13432 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013433
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013434backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013435 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013436 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13437
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013438curves <curves>
13439 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13440 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13441 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13442 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13443 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13444 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13445
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013446ecdhe <named curve>
13447 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013448 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13449 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013450
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013451ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013452 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13453 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13454 client's certificate.
13455
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013456ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13457 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13458 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13459 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13460 error is ignored.
13461
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013462ca-sign-file <cafile>
13463 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13464 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13465 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13466 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13467 'generate-certificates' for details.
13468
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013469ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013470 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13471 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13472 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13473 'generate-certificates' for details.
13474
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013475ca-verify-file <cafile>
13476 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13477 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13478 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13479 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13480 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13481
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013482ciphers <ciphers>
13483 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13484 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013485 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013486 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013487 information and recommendations see e.g.
13488 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13489 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13490 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13491
13492ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13493 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13494 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13495 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13496 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013497 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13498 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013499
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013500crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013501 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13502 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013503 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13504 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013505
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013506crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013507 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13508 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13509 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13510 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13511 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013512 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13513 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013514
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013515 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13516 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13517
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013518 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13519 are loaded.
13520
13521 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013522 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13523 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13524 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13525 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13526 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13527 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13528 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013529 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013530
13531 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13532 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13533 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13534 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013535 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13536 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013537
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013538 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013539
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013540 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013541 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013542 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13543 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013544 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13545 clients).
13546
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013547 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013548 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13549 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13550 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13551 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13552 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13553 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13554 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13555 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13556 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13557 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13558 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13559 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13560
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013561 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013562 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13563 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13564 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13565 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13566
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013567 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13568 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13569 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13570 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013571
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013572 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13573 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13574 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013575
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013576crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013577 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013578 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013579 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013580 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013581
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013582crt-list <file>
13583 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013584 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13585 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013586
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013587 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13588
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013589 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13590 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13591 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13592 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13593 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013594
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013595 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013596 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13597 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13598 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13599 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13600 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013601 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13602 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13603 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013604
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013605 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13606 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13607 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013608
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013609 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13610
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013611 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013612 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013613 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13614 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13615 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13616 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13617 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13618 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013619
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013620 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013621 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013622 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013623 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013624 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013625 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013626
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013627defer-accept
13628 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13629 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13630 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013631 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013632 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13633 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13634 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13635 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13636 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13637 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13638 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13639
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013640expose-fd listeners
13641 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13642 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013643 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13644 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013645 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013646
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013647force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013648 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013649 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013650 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013651 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013652
13653force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013654 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013655 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013656 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013657
13658force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013659 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013660 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013661 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013662
13663force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013664 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013665 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013666 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013667
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013668force-tlsv13
13669 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13670 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013671 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013672
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013673generate-certificates
13674 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13675 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13676 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13677 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13678 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13679 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13680 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13681 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13682 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13683 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13684 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13685
13686 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13687 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013688 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013689 certificate is used many times.
13690
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013691gid <gid>
13692 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13693 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13694 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13695 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13696 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13697
13698group <group>
13699 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13700 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13701 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13702 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13703 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13704
13705id <id>
13706 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13707 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13708 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13709 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13710
13711interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013712 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13713 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13714 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13715 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13716 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13717 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013718 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13719 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13720 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13721 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13722 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13723 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013724
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013725level <level>
13726 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13727 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13728 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013729 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013730 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13731 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13732 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013733 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013734 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013735 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013736 all counters).
13737
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013738severity-output <format>
13739 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13740 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13741 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13742 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13743 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13744 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13745 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13746 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13747 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13748 rfc5424 convention.
13749
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013750maxconn <maxconn>
13751 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13752 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13753 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13754 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13755 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13756 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13757 eat all memory.
13758
13759mode <mode>
13760 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13761 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13762 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13763 UNIX sockets.
13764
13765mss <maxseg>
13766 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13767 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13768 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13769 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13770 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13771 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13772 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13773 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13774 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13775 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13776 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13777
13778name <name>
13779 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13780 page.
13781
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013782namespace <name>
13783 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13784 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13785 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13786 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13787
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013788nice <nice>
13789 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13790 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13791 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13792 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13793 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13794 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13795 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13796 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13797 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13798 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13799 one for an RDP socket.
13800
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013801no-ca-names
13802 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13803 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013804 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013805
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013806no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013807 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013808 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013809 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013810 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013811 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13812 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013813
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013814no-tls-tickets
13815 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13816 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13817 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013818 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13819 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013820 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13821 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13822 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013823
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013824no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013825 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013826 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013827 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013828 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013829 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13830 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013831
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013832no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013833 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013834 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013835 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013836 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013837 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13838 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013839
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013840no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013841 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013842 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013843 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013844 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013845 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13846 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013847
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013848no-tlsv13
13849 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13850 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13851 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13852 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013853 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13854 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013855
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013856npn <protocols>
13857 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13858 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13859 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013860 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013861 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013862 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13863 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13864 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13865 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13866 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013867
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013868prefer-client-ciphers
13869 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13870 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13871 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013872 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13873 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13874 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013875
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013876process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013877 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013878 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013879 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013880 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13881 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13882 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13883 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013884 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013885 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13886 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13887 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13888 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13889 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013890
13891 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13892
13893 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13894 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13895 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13896 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13897 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13898 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13899 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13900 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013901
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013902proto <name>
13903 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13904 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13905 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013906 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13907 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13908
13909 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13910 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13911 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13912 also reported (flag=HTX).
13913
13914 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13915 a bind line :
13916
13917 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13918 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13919 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13920
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013921 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013922 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013923 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013924 h2" on the bind line.
13925
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013926ssl
13927 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013928 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013929 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13930 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013931 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13932 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013933
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013934ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13935 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013936 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13937 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13938 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013939 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13940
13941ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013942 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13943 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13944 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13945 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013946
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013947strict-sni
13948 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13949 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13950 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13951 See the "crt" option for more information.
13952
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013953tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013954 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013955 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013956 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013957 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013958 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13959 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13960 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13961 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13962 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13963 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13964 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13965
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013966tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013967 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013968 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13969 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13970 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13971 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13972 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13973 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13974 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013975 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13976 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13977 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013978
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013979tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13980 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013981 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13982 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13983 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13984 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13985 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13986 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13987 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13988 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13989 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13990 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013991 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13992 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13993
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013994transparent
13995 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13996 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13997 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13998 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13999 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
14000 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
14001 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
14002 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
14003 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
14004 so check for support with your vendor.
14005
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014006v4v6
14007 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14008 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
14009 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
14010 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014011 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014012
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014013v6only
14014 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14015 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
14016 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014017 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
14018 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014019
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014020uid <uid>
14021 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
14022 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14023 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
14024 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
14025 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14026
14027user <user>
14028 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
14029 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14030 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
14031 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
14032 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14033
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014034verify [none|optional|required]
14035 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14036 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14037 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14038 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14039 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014040 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14041 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14042 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14043 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014044
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200140455.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014046------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014047
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014048The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14049which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14050arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14051settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14052after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14053Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14054address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014055
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014056 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014057 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014058
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014059Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14060keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14061
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014062The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014063
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014064addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014065 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014066 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14067 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14068 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14069 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14070 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014071
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014072agent-check
14073 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014074 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014075 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14076 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14077 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014078
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014079 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014080 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014081 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014082 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14083 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014084
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014085 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14086 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14087 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14088 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14089 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014090
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014091 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014092 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014093
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014094 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14095 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14096 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014097
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014098 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14099 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14100 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014101
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014102 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014103 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14104 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14105 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14106 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014107 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014108 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014109
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014110 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14111 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014112
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014113 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14114 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14115 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14116 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14117 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14118 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14119 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14120 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14121 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014122
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014123 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14124 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014125 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14126 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14127 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014128 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014129
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014130 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014131 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014132
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014133agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014134 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014135 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14136 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14137 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14138 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14139
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014140agent-inter <delay>
14141 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14142 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14143
14144 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14145 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14146 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14147 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14148 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14149 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14150 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14151 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14152 of backends use the same servers.
14153
14154 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14155
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014156agent-addr <addr>
14157 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14158
14159 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014160 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014161 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14162 hostname, it will be resolved.
14163
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014164agent-port <port>
14165 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14166
14167 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14168
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014169allow-0rtt
14170 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014171 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14172 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014173
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014174alpn <protocols>
14175 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14176 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14177 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014178 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014179 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14180 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14181 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14182 now obsolete NPN extension.
14183 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14184 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14185
14186 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14187
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014188 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
14189
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014190backup
14191 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14192 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14193 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14194 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014195 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14196 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014197
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014198ca-file <cafile>
14199 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14200 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14201 server's certificate.
14202
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014203check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014204 This option enables health checks on a server:
14205 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14206 considered available.
14207 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14208 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14209 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14210 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14211 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14212 set.
14213 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14214 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14215 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14216 exchanges succeed.
14217
14218 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14219 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14220 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14221 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14222 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014223 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014224 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14225
14226 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14227 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14228
14229 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14230 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14231
14232 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14233 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14234 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14235 available.
14236
14237 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14238 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14239 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14240
14241 Example:
14242 # simple tcp check
14243 backend foo
14244 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14245 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14246 backend foo
14247 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14248 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14249 backend foo
14250 option tcp-check
14251 tcp-check connect
14252 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014253
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014254check-send-proxy
14255 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14256 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14257 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14258 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14259 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14260 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14261 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14262
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014263check-alpn <protocols>
14264 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14265 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14266 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14267
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014268check-proto <name>
14269 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14270 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14271 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014272 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14273 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14274
14275 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14276 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14277 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14278 also reported (flag=HTX).
14279
14280 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14281 directive on a server line:
14282
14283 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14284 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14285 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14286 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14287
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014288 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014289 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14290 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14291
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014292check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014293 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014294 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14295 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014296
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014297check-ssl
14298 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14299 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14300 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14301 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014302 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014303 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14304 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014305 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014306 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14307 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014308
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014309check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014310 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014311 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14312 for normal traffic.
14313
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014314ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014315 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14316 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14317 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014318 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14319 information and recommendations see e.g.
14320 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14321 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14322 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014323
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014324ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14325 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14326 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14327 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14328 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014329 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14330 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14331 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014332
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014333cookie <value>
14334 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14335 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14336 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14337 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14338 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14339 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14340 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14341
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014342crl-file <crlfile>
14343 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14344 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14345 to verify server's certificate.
14346
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014347crt <cert>
14348 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14349 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14350 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14351 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14352 certificate request.
14353
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014354 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14355 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14356 option is set accordingly).
14357
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014358disabled
14359 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14360 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14361 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14362 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14363 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014364 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014365
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014366enabled
14367 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14368 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14369 default value.
14370 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14371 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014372
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014373error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014374 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14375 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14376 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014377
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014378 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014379
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014380fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014381 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14382 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14383 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14384
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014385force-sslv3
14386 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14387 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014388 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014389 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014390
14391force-tlsv10
14392 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014393 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014394 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014395
14396force-tlsv11
14397 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014398 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014399 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014400
14401force-tlsv12
14402 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014403 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014404 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014405
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014406force-tlsv13
14407 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14408 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014409 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014410
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014411id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014412 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14413 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14414 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014415
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014416init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14417 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14418 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014419 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014420 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14421 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14422 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14423 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14424 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14425 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14426 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14427 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14428 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014429 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014430 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14431 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14432 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14433 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14434 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14435 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014436 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014437
14438 Example:
14439 defaults
14440 # never fail on address resolution
14441 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14442
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014443inter <delay>
14444fastinter <delay>
14445downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014446 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14447 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14448 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14449 between checks depending on the server state :
14450
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014451 Server state | Interval used
14452 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14453 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14454 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14455 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14456 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14457 or yet unchecked. |
14458 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14459 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14460 | "inter" otherwise.
14461 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014462
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014463 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14464 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14465 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14466 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014467 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14468 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14469 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14470 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14471 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014472
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014473log-proto <logproto>
14474 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14475 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14476 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14477 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14478
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014479maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014480 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14481 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014482 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14483 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014484 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14485 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14486 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14487 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14488
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014489 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14490 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14491 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14492 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14493 than 50 concurrent requests.
14494
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014495maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014496 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14497 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14498 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14499 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014500 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14501 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14502 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14503 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14504 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14505 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14506 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014507
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014508max-reuse <count>
14509 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14510 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14511 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14512 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14513 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14514 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14515 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14516 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14517
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014518minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014519 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14520 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14521 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14522 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14523 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14524 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014525 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014526 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014527
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014528namespace <name>
14529 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14530 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14531 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14532 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14533
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014534no-agent-check
14535 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14536 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14537 default value.
14538 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14539 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14540
14541no-backup
14542 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14543 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14544 default value.
14545 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14546 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14547
14548no-check
14549 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14550 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14551 default value.
14552 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14553 "default-server" "check" setting.
14554
14555no-check-ssl
14556 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14557 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14558 default value.
14559 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14560 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14561
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014562no-send-proxy
14563 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14564 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14565 default value.
14566 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14567 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14568
14569no-send-proxy-v2
14570 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14571 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14572 default value.
14573 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14574 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14575
14576no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14577 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14578 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14579 default value.
14580 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14581 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14582
14583no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14584 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14585 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14586 default value.
14587 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14588 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14589
14590no-ssl
14591 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14592 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14593 default value.
14594 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14595 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14596
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014597 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14598 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14599 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14600
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014601no-ssl-reuse
14602 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14603 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14604 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14605 and for paranoid users.
14606
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014607no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014608 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14609 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014610 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014611
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014612 Supported in default-server: No
14613
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014614no-tls-tickets
14615 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14616 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14617 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014618 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14619 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014620 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14621 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14622 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014623 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014624
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014625no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014626 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014627 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14628 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014629 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14630 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014631 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014632
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014633 Supported in default-server: No
14634
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014635no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014636 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014637 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14638 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014639 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14640 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014641 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014642
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014643 Supported in default-server: No
14644
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014645no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014646 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014647 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14648 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014649 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14650 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014651 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014652
14653 Supported in default-server: No
14654
14655no-tlsv13
14656 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14657 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14658 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14659 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14660 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014661 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014662
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014663 Supported in default-server: No
14664
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014665no-verifyhost
14666 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14667 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14668 default value.
14669 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14670 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014671
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014672no-tfo
14673 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14674 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14675 default value.
14676 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14677 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14678
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014679non-stick
14680 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14681 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14682 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14683
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014684npn <protocols>
14685 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14686 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14687 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014688 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014689 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14690 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14691 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14692
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014693observe <mode>
14694 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14695 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14696 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14697 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14698 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14699 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014700 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014701
14702 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14703
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014704on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014705 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14706 Currently, four modes are available:
14707 - fastinter: force fastinter
14708 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14709 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14710 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14711 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14712
14713 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14714
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014715on-marked-down <action>
14716 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14717 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014718 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14719 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14720 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14721 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14722 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14723 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14724 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14725 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014726
14727 Actions are disabled by default
14728
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014729on-marked-up <action>
14730 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14731 Currently one action is available:
14732 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14733 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14734 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14735 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014736 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14737 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014738 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14739 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14740
14741 Actions are disabled by default
14742
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014743pool-low-conn <max>
14744 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14745 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14746 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14747 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14748 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14749 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14750 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14751 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14752 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14753 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014754 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14755 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14756 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14757 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014758
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014759pool-max-conn <max>
14760 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14761 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14762 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14763 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14764 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14765 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14766
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014767pool-purge-delay <delay>
14768 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014769 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014770 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014771
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014772port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014773 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014774 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14775 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14776 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14777 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14778 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014779
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014780proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014781 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14782 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14783 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014784 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14785 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14786
14787 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14788 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14789 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14790 also reported (flag=HTX).
14791
14792 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14793 a server line :
14794
14795 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14796 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14797 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14798 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14799
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014800 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014801 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14802
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014803 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
14804
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014805redir <prefix>
14806 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14807 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14808 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14809 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14810 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14811 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14812 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14813 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014814 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014815 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014816 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14817 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14818 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14819 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14820
14821 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14822
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014823rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014824 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14825 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14826 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14827
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014828resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14829 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14830 server.
14831
14832 Available options:
14833
14834 * allow-dup-ip
14835 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14836 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14837 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14838 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14839 For such case, simply enable this option.
14840 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14841
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014842 * ignore-weight
14843 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14844 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14845 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14846
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014847 * prevent-dup-ip
14848 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14849 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14850 same fqdn.
14851 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14852
14853 Example:
14854 backend b_myapp
14855 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14856 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14857 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14858
14859 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14860 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14861 it
14862 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14863 different address
14864
14865 Default value: not set
14866
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014867resolve-prefer <family>
14868 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14869 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14870 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14871 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14872
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014873 Default value: ipv6
14874
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014875 Example:
14876
14877 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014878
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014879resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014880 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014881 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014882 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014883 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14884 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014885 configured network, another address is selected.
14886
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014887 Example:
14888
14889 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014890
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014891resolvers <id>
14892 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14893 hostname.
14894
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014895 Example:
14896
14897 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014898
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014899 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014900
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014901send-proxy
14902 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14903 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14904 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14905 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014906 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14907 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14908 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14909 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014910 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014911 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14912 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14913 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14914 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14915 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014916 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14917 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014918
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014919send-proxy-v2
14920 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14921 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14922 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14923 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014924 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14925 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14926 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14927 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014928
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014929proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014930 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14931 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14932
14933 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14934 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14935 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14936 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14937 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14938 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14939 connection is supported).
14940 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14941 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14942 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14943 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14944 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14945 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14946 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014947
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014948send-proxy-v2-ssl
14949 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14950 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14951 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14952 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14953 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14954 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14955 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014956 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14957 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014958
14959send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14960 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14961 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14962 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14963 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14964 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14965 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14966 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14967 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014968 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14969 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014970
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014971slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014972 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14973 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14974 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14975 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14976 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14977 parameters :
14978
14979 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14980 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14981
14982 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14983 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14984 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14985 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14986
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014987 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014988 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14989 seen as failed.
14990
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014991sni <expression>
14992 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14993 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14994 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14995 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014996 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14997 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014998 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014999 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
15000 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015001
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015002source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020015003source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015004source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015005 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
15006 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
15007 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
15008 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
15009
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015010 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
15011 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
15012 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
15013 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
15014 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
15015 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
15016 server.
15017
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000015018 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
15019 specifying the source address without port(s).
15020
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015021ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020015022 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
15023 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
15024 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
15025 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
15026 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
15027 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015028 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
15029 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015030
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015031ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15032 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
15033 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15034 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15035
15036ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15037 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
15038 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15039 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
15040
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015041ssl-reuse
15042 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15043 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15044 default value.
15045 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15046 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15047
15048stick
15049 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15050 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15051 default value.
15052 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15053 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015054
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015055socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015056 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015057 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15058 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15059
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015060tcp-ut <delay>
15061 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015062 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015063 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015064 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015065 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15066 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15067 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15068 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15069 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15070 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15071 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15072 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15073 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15074
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015075tfo
15076 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15077 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15078 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15079 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015080 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015081 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015082
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015083track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015084 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15085 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15086 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
15087 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015088 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15089
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015090tls-tickets
15091 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15092 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15093 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015094 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15095 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15096 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015097 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015098 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015099
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015100verify [none|required]
15101 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015102 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015103 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15104 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015105 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015106 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15107 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15108 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15109 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15110 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15111 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15112 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15113 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015114
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015115verifyhost <hostname>
15116 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015117 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15118 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15119 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15120 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15121 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15122 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15123 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15124 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015125
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015126weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015127 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15128 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15129 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015130 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15131 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15132 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15133 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15134 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15135 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015136
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015137ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
15138 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
15139 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
15140 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
15141
15142 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
15143 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
15144 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
15145 server ALPN contains it.
15146
15147 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
15148 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
15149 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
15150 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
15151
15152 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
15153 favor of the ALPN extension.
15154
15155 See also "alpn" and "proto".
15156
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015157
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151585.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15159-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015160
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015161HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15162using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015163configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015164This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15165can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15166workload.
15167This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15168resolution at run time.
15169Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15170carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15171
15172
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151735.3.1. Global overview
15174----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015175
15176As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15177different steps of the process life:
15178
15179 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15180 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15181 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15182
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015183 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15184 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015185
15186A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15187 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15188 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15189 resolution to know this new IP.
15190
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015191When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015192HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015193SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15194from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015195will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015196will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015197
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015198A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015199 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015200 first valid response.
15201
15202 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15203 servers return an error.
15204
15205
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200152065.3.2. The resolvers section
15207----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015208
15209This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015210HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15211contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015212
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015213When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15214uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15215is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15216answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15217
15218When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015219used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015220
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015221 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15222 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15223 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015224
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015225 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15226 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015227
Thierry Fournierfc13f792021-12-15 19:03:52 +010015228 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015229 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15230 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015231
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015232For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15233following scenarios are possible:
15234
15235 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15236 ignored
15237
15238 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15239 applied
15240
15241 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15242 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15243
15244 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15245 retries the query with a new type
15246
15247 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15248 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015249
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015250As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015251a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015252<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015253
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015254
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015255resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015256 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015257
15258A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15259
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015260accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015261 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015262 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015263 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15264 by RFC 6891)
15265
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015266 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15267 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15268 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15269 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15270 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15271 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015272
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015273nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15274 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15275 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15276 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15277 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15278 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15279 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15280 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15281 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15282 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015283 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15284
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015285parse-resolv-conf
15286 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15287 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15288 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15289
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015290hold <status> <period>
15291 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15292 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015293 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015294 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015295 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15296 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15297 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15298
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015299 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015300
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015301resolve_retries <nb>
15302 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15303 giving up.
15304 Default value: 3
15305
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015306 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15307 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15308 type.
15309
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015310timeout <event> <time>
15311 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15312 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15313 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015314 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15315 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015316 Default value: 1s
15317 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015318 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015319 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015320 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15321 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15322
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015323 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015324
15325 resolvers mydns
15326 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15327 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015328 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015329 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015330 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015331 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015332 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015333 hold other 30s
15334 hold refused 30s
15335 hold nx 30s
15336 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015337 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015338 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015339
15340
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200153416. Cache
15342---------
15343
15344HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15345(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15346RAM.
15347
15348The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
15349this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
15350
15351If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15352independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15353when we try to allocate a new one.
15354
15355The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15356
15357It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15358"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15359for more details.
15360
15361When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15362replaced by "<CACHE>".
15363
15364
153656.1. Limitation
15366----------------
15367
15368The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15369
15370- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015371- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15372 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15373 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015374- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15375- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015376- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15377 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15378 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015379- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15380 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015381- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15382 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15383 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015384
15385- If the request is not a GET
15386- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15387- If the request contains an Authorization header
15388
15389
153906.2. Setup
15391-----------
15392
15393To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15394the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15395
15396
153976.2.1. Cache section
15398---------------------
15399
15400cache <name>
15401 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15402 size of cache is mandatory.
15403
15404total-max-size <megabytes>
15405 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15406 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15407
15408max-object-size <bytes>
15409 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15410 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15411 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15412
15413max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015414 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015415 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15416 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15417 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15418 default.
15419
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015420process-vary <on/off>
15421 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015422 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15423 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15424 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015425 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015426
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015427max-secondary-entries <number>
15428 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15429 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15430 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15431
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015432
154336.2.2. Proxy section
15434---------------------
15435
15436http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15437 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15438 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15439 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15440 after this one.
15441
15442http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15443 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15444 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15445 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15446 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15447
15448
15449Example:
15450
15451 backend bck1
15452 mode http
15453
15454 http-request cache-use foobar
15455 http-response cache-store foobar
15456 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15457
15458 cache foobar
15459 total-max-size 4
15460 max-age 240
15461
15462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200154637. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15464----------------------------------
15465
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015466HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015467client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15468The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15469these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15470but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15471data called patterns.
15472
15473
154747.1. ACL basics
15475---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015476
15477The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15478content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15479from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15480simple :
15481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015482 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015483 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015484 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15485 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015487The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15488adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015489
15490In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015492 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015493
15494This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15495Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15496and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015497an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15498conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15499as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15500are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015501
15502ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15503'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15504which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15505
15506There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15507performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015509The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15510specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15511this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015512methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15513ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015514
15515Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15516 - boolean
15517 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15518 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15519 - string
15520 - data block
15521
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015522Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15523converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15524would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15525The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15526which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15527
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015528Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15529keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15530fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15531which are summarized in the table below :
15532
15533 +---------------------+-----------------+
15534 | Sample or converter | Default |
15535 | output type | matching method |
15536 +---------------------+-----------------+
15537 | boolean | bool |
15538 +---------------------+-----------------+
15539 | integer | int |
15540 +---------------------+-----------------+
15541 | ip | ip |
15542 +---------------------+-----------------+
15543 | string | str |
15544 +---------------------+-----------------+
15545 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15546 +---------------------+-----------------+
15547
15548Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15549matching method, see below.
15550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015551The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15552 - boolean
15553 - integer or integer range
15554 - IP address / network
15555 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15556 - regular expression
15557 - hex block
15558
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015559The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15560
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015561 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15562 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015563 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015564 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015565 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015566 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015567 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015569The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15570read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15571if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15572lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15573will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15574beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015575a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015576lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15577exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15578
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015579The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15580parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15581ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15582a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15583check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15584
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015585The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15586socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15587file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015589Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15590loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15591
15592 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15593
15594In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15595the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15596case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15597as well.
15598
15599The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15600sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15601do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15602methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15603is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015604obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015605followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15606default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15607that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15608string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15609
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015610The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15611By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15612string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15613resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015614server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015615waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015616flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15617function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015619There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15620sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15621be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015622
15623 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15624 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015625 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15626 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15627 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15628 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015629
15630 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15631 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015632 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015633
15634 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015635 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015636
15637 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015638 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015639
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015640 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015641 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15642
15643 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15644 binary or string samples.
15645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015646 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15647 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015649 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15650 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15651 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015653 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15654 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015656 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15657 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015659 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15660 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015662 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15663 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015664 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015666 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15667 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15668 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015669
15670For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15671request, it is possible to do :
15672
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015673 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015674
15675In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15676buffer, one would use the following acl :
15677
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015678 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015679
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015680On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15681possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15682
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015683 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015685All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15686criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15687method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15688to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15689criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15690the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015692If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015693the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15694For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015696 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15697 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15698 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15699 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015700
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015701
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015702The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15703types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15704combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15705brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15706default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015708 +-------------------------------------------------+
15709 | Input sample type |
15710 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015711 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015712 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15713 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15714 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015715 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015716 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015717 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015718 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015719 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015720 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015721 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015722 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015723 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015724 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015725 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015726 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015727 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015728 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015729 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015730 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015731 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015732 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015733 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015734 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015735 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015736 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15737 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15738 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015739
15740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157417.1.1. Matching booleans
15742------------------------
15743
15744In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15745Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15746When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15747that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15748
15749Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15750return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15751"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15752
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157547.1.2. Matching integers
15755------------------------
15756
15757Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15758enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15759to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15760
15761Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15762matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15763lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015764
15765For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15766unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15767representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15768
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015769As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15770two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15771instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15772ranges and operators.
15773
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015774For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015775operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15776Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15777of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015778
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015779Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015780
15781 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15782 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15783 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15784 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15785 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15786
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015787For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015788
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015789 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015790
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015791This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15792
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015793 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015794
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157967.1.3. Matching strings
15797-----------------------
15798
15799String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15800different forms :
15801
15802 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015803 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015804
15805 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015806 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015807
15808 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15809 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15810
15811 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15812 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15813
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015814 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015815 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15816 matches.
15817
15818 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15819 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15820 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015821
15822String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15823exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15824characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15825string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15826to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015827before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015828
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015829Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15830(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15831Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15832
15833Example:
15834 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15835 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15836
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158387.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15839---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015840
15841Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15842they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15843possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15844passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15845the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015846the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15847match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015848
15849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158507.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15851-------------------------------------
15852
15853It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15854not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15855a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15856to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15857digits may be used upper or lower case.
15858
15859Example :
15860 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015861 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015862
15863
158647.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15865---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015866
15867IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15868netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15869within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015870host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015871difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15872at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15873does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15874parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015875
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015876The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15877abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15878
15879 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15880 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15881 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15882 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15883 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15884 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15885 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15886 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15887
15888Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15889192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15890
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015891IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15892Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15893trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15894IPv6 patterns.
15895
15896HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15897following situations :
15898 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15899 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15900 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15901 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15902 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15903 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15904 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15905 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15906 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15907 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015909
159107.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15911----------------------------------
15912
15913Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15914combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15915
15916 - AND (implicit)
15917 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15918 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015920A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015922 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015924Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15925indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015927For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15928"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15929requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15930is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15931
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015932 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015933 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15934 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15935 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015936
15937To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15938and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15939
15940 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15941 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15942 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15943 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15944
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015945 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015946 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15947 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15948 use_backend www if host_www
15949
15950It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15951expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15952be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15953the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15954
15955 The following rule :
15956
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015957 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015958 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015959
15960 Can also be written that way :
15961
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015962 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015963
15964It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15965to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15966simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15967sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15968good use is the following :
15969
15970 With named ACLs :
15971
15972 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15973 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15974 monitor fail if site_dead
15975
15976 With anonymous ACLs :
15977
15978 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15979
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015980See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15981keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015982
15983
159847.3. Fetching samples
15985---------------------
15986
15987Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15988against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15989sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15990ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15991of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15992available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15993
15994This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15995Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15996compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15997deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15998
15999The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
16000matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
16001method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
16002indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
16003
16004As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
16005when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
16006mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
16007the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
16008ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
16009
16010Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
16011multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
16012when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016013incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
16014are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016015is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
16016all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
16017
16018Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
16019 - name
16020 - name(arg1)
16021 - name(arg1,arg2)
16022
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016023
160247.3.1. Converters
16025-----------------
16026
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016027Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
16028of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
16029is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
16030was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016031has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016032unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
16033
16034These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
16035sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
16036the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016037support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016038
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016039A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
16040support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
16041supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
16042(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
16043bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
16044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016045The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016046
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001604751d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
16048 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16049 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16050 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
16051 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16052 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16053
16054 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016055 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
16056 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000016057 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
16058 frontend http-in
16059 bind *:8081
16060 default_backend servers
16061 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16062 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16063
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016064add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016065 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016066 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016067 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16068 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016069 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016070 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16071 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16072 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16073 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016074 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016075 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016076
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010016077aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
16078 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
16079 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
16080 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
16081 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
16082 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
16083 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
16084
16085 Example:
16086 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
16087 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
16088
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016089and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016090 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016091 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016092 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16093 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016094 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016095 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16096 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16097 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16098 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016099 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016100 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016101
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016102b64dec
16103 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
16104 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016105 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
16106 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016107
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016108base64
16109 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016110 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016111 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16112 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016113
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016114bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016115 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016116 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016117 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016118 presence of a flag).
16119
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016120bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16121 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16122 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016123 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016124
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016125concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16126 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16127 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16128 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16129 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16130 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16131 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16132 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16133 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16134 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16135 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016136 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016137 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016138 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
16139 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016140
16141 Example:
16142 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16143 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16144 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016145 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016146 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16147
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016148cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016149 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16150 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016151
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016152crc32([<avalanche>])
16153 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16154 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16155 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16156 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16157 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16158 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16159 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16160 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16161 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16162 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016163 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16164
16165crc32c([<avalanche>])
16166 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16167 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16168 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16169 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16170 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16171 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16172 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16173 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016174
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016175cut_crlf
16176 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16177 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16178 updated.
16179
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016180da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016181 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16182 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16183 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16184 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016185 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016186 configuration language.
16187
16188 Example:
16189 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016190 bind *:8881
16191 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016192 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016193
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016194debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16195 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16196 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16197 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16198 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16199 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16200 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16201 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16202 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16203 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16204 printable sample types.
16205
16206 Example:
16207 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016208
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016209digest(<algorithm>)
16210 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16211 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16212
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016213 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016214 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16215
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016216div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016217 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16218 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016219 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016220 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16221 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016222 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016223 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16224 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16225 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16226 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016227 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016228 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016229
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016230djb2([<avalanche>])
16231 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16232 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16233 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16234 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16235 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16236 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16237 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016238 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16239 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016240
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016241even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016242 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016243 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16244
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016245field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16246 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16247 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16248 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16249 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16250 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16251 fields.
16252
16253 Example :
16254 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16255 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16256 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16257 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16258 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016259
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016260fix_is_valid
16261 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16262 Information eXchange):
16263
16264 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16265 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016266 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016267 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016268 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016269 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16270 checksum
16271
16272 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16273 the server can be parsed.
16274
16275 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16276 message, false if not.
16277
16278 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16279
16280 Example:
16281 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16282 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16283
16284fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16285 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16286 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16287 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16288 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016289 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016290 added.
16291
16292 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16293 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16294 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16295 fix_is_valid converter.
16296
16297 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16298
16299 Example:
16300 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16301 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16302 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16303 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16304 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16305
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016306hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016307 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016308 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016309 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016310 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016311
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016312hex2i
16313 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016314 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016315
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016316htonl
16317 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16318 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16319 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16320 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16321
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016322hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016323 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16324 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16325 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16326 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16327
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016328 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016329 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16330
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016331http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016332 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16333 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016334 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16335 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16336 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16337 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16338 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16339 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16340 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16341 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016342
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016343iif(<true>,<false>)
16344 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16345 string otherwise.
16346
16347 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016348 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016349
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016350in_table(<table>)
16351 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16352 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16353 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016354 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016355 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16356
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016357ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016358 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016359 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016360 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16361 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16362 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16363 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16364 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016365
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016366json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016367 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016368 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016369 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016370 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16371 of errors:
16372 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16373 bytes, ...)
16374 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16375 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16376
16377 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16378 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16379 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16380 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16381 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16382 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016383 - "ascii" : never fails;
16384 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16385 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016386 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016387 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016388 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16389 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16390
16391 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016392 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016393
16394 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016395 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016396 capture request header user-agent len 150
16397 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016398
16399 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16400 GET / HTTP/1.0
16401 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16402
16403 Output log:
16404 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16405
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016406json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16407 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16408 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16409 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16410 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16411
16412 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16413 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16414
16415 Example:
16416 # get a integer value from the request body
16417 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16418 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16419
16420 # get a key with '.' in the name
16421 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16422 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16423
16424 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16425 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16426
16427 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16428 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16429
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016430language(<value>[,<default>])
16431 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16432 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16433 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16434 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16435 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16436 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16437 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16438 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16439 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016440 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016441 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16442 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016443
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016444 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016445
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016446 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16447 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016448
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016449 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16450 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16451 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16452 use_backend spanish if es
16453 use_backend french if fr
16454 use_backend english if en
16455 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016456
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016457length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016458 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16459 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16460 type. The result is of type integer.
16461
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016462lower
16463 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16464 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16465 type. The result is of type string.
16466
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016467ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16468 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16469 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16470 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16471 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16472 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16473 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16474
16475 Example :
16476
16477 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016478 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016479 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16480
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016481ltrim(<chars>)
16482 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16483 representation of the input sample.
16484
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016485map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16486map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16487map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16488 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16489 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16490 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16491 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16492 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16493 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16494 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16495 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016496
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016497 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16498 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16499 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016500
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016501 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016502 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016503
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016504 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16505 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16506 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16507 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016508 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16509 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016510 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16511 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16512 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16513 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16514 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16515 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16516 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16517 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016518 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16519 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16520 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016521 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16522 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16523 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16524 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16525 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016526
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016527 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16528 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16529 the corresponding match text.
16530
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016531 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16532 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16533 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16534 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16535 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016536
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016537 Example :
16538
16539 # this is a comment and is ignored
16540 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16541 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16542 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16543 | | | `---------- value
16544 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16545 | `---------------------------- key
16546 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16547
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016548mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016549 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16550 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016551 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016552 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016553 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016554 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16555 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16556 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16557 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016558 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016559 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016560
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016561mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016562 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16563 <packettype>.
16564 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16565 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16566 from.
16567 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16568 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16569 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16570
16571 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16572 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16573 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16574 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16575
16576 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16577 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16578 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16579 packets only):
16580 17: Session Expiry Interval
16581 33: Receive Maximum
16582 39: Maximum Packet Size
16583 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16584 25: Request Response Information
16585 23: Request Problem Information
16586 21: Authentication Method
16587 22: Authentication Data
16588 18: Will Delay Interval
16589 1: Payload Format Indicator
16590 2: Message Expiry Interval
16591 3: Content Type
16592 8: Response Topic
16593 9: Correlation Data
16594 Not supported yet:
16595 38: User Property
16596
16597 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16598 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16599 packets only):
16600 17: Session Expiry Interval
16601 33: Receive Maximum
16602 36: Maximum QoS
16603 37: Retain Available
16604 39: Maximum Packet Size
16605 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16606 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16607 31: Reason String
16608 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16609 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16610 42: Shared Subscription Available
16611 19: Server Keep Alive
16612 26: Response Information
16613 28: Server Reference
16614 21: Authentication Method
16615 22: Authentication Data
16616 Not supported yet:
16617 38: User Property
16618
16619 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16620 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16621 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16622 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16623
16624 Example:
16625
16626 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16627 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16628 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16629 if data_in_buffer
16630 # do the same as above
16631 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16632 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16633 if data_in_buffer
16634
16635mqtt_is_valid
16636 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16637
16638 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16639 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16640 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16641 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16642
Christopher Fauletc7907732022-03-22 09:41:11 +010016643 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
16644
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016645 Example:
16646
16647 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040016648 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016649
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016650mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016651 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016652 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16653 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016654 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016655 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016656 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016657 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16658 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16659 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16660 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016661 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016662 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016663
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016664nbsrv
16665 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16666 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16667 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16668 map lookup.
16669
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016670neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016671 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16672 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16673 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16674 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016675
16676not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016677 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016678 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016679 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016680 absence of a flag).
16681
16682odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016683 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016684 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16685
16686or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016687 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016688 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016689 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16690 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016691 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016692 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16693 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16694 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16695 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016696 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016697 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016698
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016699protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16700 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16701 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16702 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16703 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16704 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16705 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16706 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16707 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16708 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16709 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16710 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16711
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016712regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016713 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16714 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16715 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16716 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16717 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16718 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16719 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16720 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16721 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016722 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16723 of characters with other ones.
16724
16725 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16726 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16727 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16728 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16729 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16730 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016731
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016732 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016733
16734 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16735 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16736 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016737 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016738
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016739 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16740 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16741
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016742 # capture groups and backreferences
16743 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016744 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016745 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16746
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016747capture-req(<id>)
16748 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16749 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16750
16751 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016752 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16753 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016754
16755capture-res(<id>)
16756 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16757 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16758
16759 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016760 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16761 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016762
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016763rtrim(<chars>)
16764 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16765 of the input sample.
16766
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016767sdbm([<avalanche>])
16768 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16769 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16770 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16771 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16772 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16773 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16774 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016775 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16776 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016777
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016778secure_memcmp(<var>)
16779 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16780 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16781 match.
16782
16783 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16784 performed in constant time.
16785
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016786 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016787 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16788
16789 Example :
16790
16791 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16792 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16793 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16794 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16795
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016796set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016797 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16798 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16799 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016800 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016801 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16802 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016803 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016804 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16805 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016806 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016807 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016808
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016809sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016810 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016811 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16812
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016813sha2([<bits>])
16814 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16815 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16816
16817 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16818 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16819
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016820 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016821 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16822
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016823srv_queue
16824 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16825 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16826 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16827 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16828 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16829
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016830strcmp(<var>)
16831 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16832 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16833 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16834 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16835 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16836 shorter).
16837
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016838 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16839 strings in constant time.
16840
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016841 Example :
16842
16843 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16844 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16845 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16846
16847
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016848sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016849 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16850 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016851 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016852 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16853 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016854 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016855 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16856 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016857 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016858 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16859 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016860 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016861 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016862
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016863table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16864 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16865 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16866 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16867 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16868 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16869 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16870
16871
16872table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16873 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16874 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16875 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16876 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16877 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16878 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16879
16880table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16881 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16882 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016883 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016884 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16885 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16886
16887table_conn_cur(<table>)
16888 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16889 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16890 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16891 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16892 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16893
16894table_conn_rate(<table>)
16895 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16896 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16897 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16898 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16899 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16900
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016901table_gpt0(<table>)
16902 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16903 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16904 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16905 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16906 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16907
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016908table_gpc0(<table>)
16909 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16910 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16911 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16912 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16913 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16914
16915table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16916 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16917 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16918 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16919 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16920 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16921 sample fetch keyword.
16922
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016923table_gpc1(<table>)
16924 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16925 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16926 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16927 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16928 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16929
16930table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16931 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16932 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16933 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16934 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16935 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16936 sample fetch keyword.
16937
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016938table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16939 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16940 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016941 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016942 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16943 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16944
16945table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16946 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16947 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16948 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16949 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16950 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16951 keyword.
16952
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016953table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
16954 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16955 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16956 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
16957 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16958 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16959
16960table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
16961 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16962 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16963 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
16964 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
16965 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
16966 keyword.
16967
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016968table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16969 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16970 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016971 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016972 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16973 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16974
16975table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16976 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16977 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16978 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16979 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16980 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16981 keyword.
16982
16983table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16984 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16985 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016986 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016987 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16988 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16989 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16990 keyword.
16991
16992table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16993 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16994 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016995 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016996 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16997 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16998 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
16999 keyword.
17000
17001table_server_id(<table>)
17002 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17003 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17004 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
17005 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
17006 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
17007 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
17008
17009table_sess_cnt(<table>)
17010 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17011 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017012 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017013 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
17014 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17015 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
17016 keyword.
17017
17018table_sess_rate(<table>)
17019 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17020 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17021 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
17022 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
17023 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17024 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
17025 keyword.
17026
17027table_trackers(<table>)
17028 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17029 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17030 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17031 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
17032 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
17033 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
17034 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
17035 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
17036 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
17037 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
17038
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017039ub64dec
17040 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
17041 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
17042 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
17043
17044 Example:
17045 # Decoding a JWT payload:
17046 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
17047
17048ub64enc
17049 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
17050
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017051upper
17052 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
17053 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17054 type. The result is of type string.
17055
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020017056url_dec([<in_form>])
17057 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
17058 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
17059 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
17060 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
17061 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
17062 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020017063
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010017064url_enc([<enc_type>])
17065 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
17066 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
17067 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
17068 optional argument is here for future changes.
17069
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017070ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017071 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017072 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
17073 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
17074 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017075 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17076 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17077 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17078 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017079 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017080 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17081 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017082
17083 Example:
17084 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
17085 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
17086
17087 message Point {
17088 int32 latitude = 1;
17089 int32 longitude = 2;
17090 }
17091
17092 message PPoint {
17093 Point point = 59;
17094 }
17095
17096 message Rectangle {
17097 // One corner of the rectangle.
17098 PPoint lo = 48;
17099 // The other corner of the rectangle.
17100 PPoint hi = 49;
17101 }
17102
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017103 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
17104 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
17105 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017106
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017107 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17108 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017109 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017110 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
17111
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017112 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017113
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017114 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017115
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017116 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17117 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17118 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017119
17120 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17121 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17122 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17123
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017124 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17125 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17126 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017127
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017128
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017129unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017130 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17131 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17132 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17133 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17134 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17135 response),
17136 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17137 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17138 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17139 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17140
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017141utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17142 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17143 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17144 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17145 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17146 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17147 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17148
17149 Example :
17150
17151 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017152 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017153 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17154
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017155word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17156 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17157 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17158 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017159 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017160 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17161 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17162
17163 Example :
17164 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
17165 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17166 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17167 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17168 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017169 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017170
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017171wt6([<avalanche>])
17172 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17173 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17174 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17175 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17176 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17177 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17178 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017179 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17180 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017181
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017182xor(<value>)
17183 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017184 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017185 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017186 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017187 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017188 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17189 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017190 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017191 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17192 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017193 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017194 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017195
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017196xxh3([<seed>])
17197 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17198 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17199 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17200 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17201 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17202 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17203 considered as cryptographically secure.
17204
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017205xxh32([<seed>])
17206 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17207 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17208 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17209 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17210 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17211 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17212 as cryptographically secure.
17213
17214xxh64([<seed>])
17215 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17216 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17217 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17218 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17219 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17220 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17221 as cryptographically secure.
17222
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017223
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200172247.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017225--------------------------------------------
17226
17227A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17228not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17229"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17230The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17231
17232always_false : boolean
17233 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17234 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17235
17236always_true : boolean
17237 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17238 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17239
17240avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017241 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017242 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17243 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17244 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17245 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17246 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17247 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17248 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17249 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17250 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17251 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17252 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17253 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17254 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017256be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017257 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17258 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17259 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17260 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017261 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17262
17263be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17264 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17265 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17266 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17267 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17268 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017269 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17270 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017271
17272 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17273 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17274 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017276be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17277 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17278 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17279 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017280 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017281 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17282 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017283
17284 Example :
17285 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17286 backend dynamic
17287 mode http
17288 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17289 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017290
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017291bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017292 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17293 of the string.
17294
17295bool(<bool>) : bool
17296 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17297 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017299connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17300 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017301 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017302 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17303 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017304
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017305 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017306 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017307 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17308
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017309 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17310 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017311
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017312 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017313 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017314 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017315 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017316 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017317 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017318 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017319
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017320 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17321 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017322 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017323 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017324
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017325cpu_calls : integer
17326 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17327 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17328 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17329 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17330 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17331 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17332
17333cpu_ns_avg : integer
17334 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17335 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17336 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17337 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17338 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17339 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17340 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17341 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17342 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17343 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17344 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17345
17346cpu_ns_tot : integer
17347 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17348 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17349 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17350 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17351 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17352 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17353 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17354 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17355 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17356 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17357 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17358 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17359 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17360
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017361date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017362 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017363
17364 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17365 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17366 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017367 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17368
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017369 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17370 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17371 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17372 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17373 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17374
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017375 Example :
17376
17377 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17378 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017379
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017380 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17381 # millisecond granularity
17382 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17383
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017384date_us : integer
17385 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17386 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17387 from the same timeval structure.
17388
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017389distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17390 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17391 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17392 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17393 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017394 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017395 list of supported tokens.
17396
17397distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17398 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17399 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17400 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17401 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017402 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017403 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17404 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17405 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17406 supported tokens.
17407
17408 Example :
17409 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17410 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17411 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17412 # send large files to the big farm
17413 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17414
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017415env(<name>) : string
17416 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17417 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17418 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17419 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17420 certain way.
17421
17422 Examples :
17423 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17424 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17425
17426 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017427 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017429fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17430 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017431 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17432 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017433 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17434 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017435 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017436 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17437 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017438
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017439fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17440 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17441 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17442 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017444fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17445 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17446 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17447 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17448 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17449 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17450 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17451 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17452 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017453
17454 Example :
17455 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17456 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17457 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17458 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17459 frontend mail
17460 bind :25
17461 mode tcp
17462 maxconn 100
17463 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17464 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17465 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17466 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017467
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017468hostname : string
17469 Returns the system hostname.
17470
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017471int(<integer>) : signed integer
17472 Returns a signed integer.
17473
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017474ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17475 Returns an ipv4.
17476
17477ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17478 Returns an ipv6.
17479
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017480lat_ns_avg : integer
17481 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17482 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17483 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17484 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17485 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17486 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17487 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17488 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17489 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017490 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17491 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17492 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17493 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17494 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17495 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017496
17497lat_ns_tot : integer
17498 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17499 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17500 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17501 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17502 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17503 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17504 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17505 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17506 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017507 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17508 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17509 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17510 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17511 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017512 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17513 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17514 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17515 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17516 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17517 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17518
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017519meth(<method>) : method
17520 Returns a method.
17521
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017522nbproc : integer
17523 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
17524 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
17525 and debugging purposes.
17526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017527nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17528 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17529 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17530 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017531 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17532 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17533 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017534
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017535prio_class : integer
17536 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17537 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17538 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17539
17540prio_offset : integer
17541 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17542 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17543 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17544 set-priority-offset".
17545
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017546proc : integer
17547 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
17548 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
17549 debugging purposes.
17550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017551queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017552 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17553 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17554 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017555 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17556 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17557 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17558 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17559 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17560
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017561rand([<range>]) : integer
17562 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17563 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17564 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17565 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17566 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017568srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17569 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17570 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17571 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17572 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17573 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017574 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17575 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17576
17577srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17578 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17579 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17580 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17581 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17582 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17583 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17584 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17585
17586 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17587 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017588
17589srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17590 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17591 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17592 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017593 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017594 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17595 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17596 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17597
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017598srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17599 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17600 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17601 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17602 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17603 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17604 fetch methods.
17605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017606srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17607 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17608 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017609 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017610 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17611 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017612 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017613 overloading servers).
17614
17615 Example :
17616 # Redirect to a separate back
17617 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17618 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17619 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17620
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017621srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017622 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17623 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17624 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17625
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017626srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017627 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17628 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17629 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17630
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017631srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017632 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17633 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17634 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17635
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017636stopping : boolean
17637 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17638 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17639 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17640
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017641str(<string>) : string
17642 Returns a string.
17643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017644table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17645 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17646 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17647
17648table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17649 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17650 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17651 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17652
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017653thread : integer
17654 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17655 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17656 and debugging purposes.
17657
Alexandar Lazica429ad32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020017658uuid([<version>]) : string
17659 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17660 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17661 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17662
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017663var(<var-name>) : undefined
17664 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017665 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17666 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017667 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017668 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17669 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017670 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017671 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17672 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017673 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017674 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017675
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200176767.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017677----------------------------------
17678
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017679The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017680closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17681methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17682sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17683TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017684the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17685counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017686"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17687used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17688can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17689Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17690table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17691tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17692currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017693
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017694bc_dst : ip
17695 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17696 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17697 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17698 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17699
17700bc_dst_port : integer
17701 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017702 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017703
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017704bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017705 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17706 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17707 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17708
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017709bc_src : ip
17710 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017711 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017712 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17713 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17714
17715bc_src_port : integer
17716 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017717 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017719be_id : integer
17720 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017721 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17722 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017723
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017724be_name : string
17725 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017726 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17727 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017728
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017729be_server_timeout : integer
17730 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17731 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17732 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17733
17734be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17735 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17736 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17737 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17738
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017739cur_server_timeout : integer
17740 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17741 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17742 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17743
17744cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17745 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17746 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17747 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017749dst : ip
17750 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17751 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17752 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17753 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017754 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17755 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17756 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17757 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17758 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17759 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017760
17761dst_conn : integer
17762 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17763 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17764 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17765 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17766 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17767 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17768 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17769 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017770
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017771dst_is_local : boolean
17772 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17773 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17774 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17775 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017776 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017777 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17778 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17779 it only once per connection.
17780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017781dst_port : integer
17782 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17783 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17784 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17785 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17786 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17787 an HTTP header.
17788
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017789fc_fackets : integer
17790 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17791 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17792 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17793 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17794
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017795fc_http_major : integer
17796 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17797 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17798 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17799
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017800fc_lost : integer
17801 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17802 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17803 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17804 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17805
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017806fc_pp_authority : string
17807 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17808 if any.
17809
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017810fc_pp_unique_id : string
17811 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17812 if any.
17813
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017814fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17815 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17816 header.
17817
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017818fc_reordering : integer
17819 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17820 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17821 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17822 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17823
17824fc_retrans : integer
17825 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17826 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17827 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17828 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17829
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017830fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17831 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17832 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17833 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17834 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17835 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17836 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17837
17838fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17839 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17840 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17841 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17842 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17843 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17844 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17845
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017846fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017847 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17848 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17849 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17850 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17851
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017852
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017853fc_unacked : integer
17854 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17855 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17856 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17857 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017858
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017859fe_defbe : string
17860 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17861 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017863fe_id : integer
17864 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017865 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017866 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17867
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017868fe_name : string
17869 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17870 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17871 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17872
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017873fe_client_timeout : integer
17874 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17875 current frontend.
17876
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017877sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017878sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17879sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17880sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017881 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17882 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17883 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17884
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017885sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017886sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17887sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17888sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017889 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17890 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17891 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17892
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017893sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017894sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17895sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17896sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017897 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17898 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017899 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17900 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17901 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017902
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017903 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017904 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17905 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017906 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17907 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17908 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017909 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17910 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17911
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017912sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17913sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17914sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17915sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17916 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17917 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17918 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17919 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17920 when a first ACL was verified.
17921
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017922sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017923sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17924sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17925sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017926 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017927 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
17928
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017929sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017930sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17931sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17932sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017933 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17934 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
17935 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
17936
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017937sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017938sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17939sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17940sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017941 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
17942 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
17943 See also src_conn_rate.
17944
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017945sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017946sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17947sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17948sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017949 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017950 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017951
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017952sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17953sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17954sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17955sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17956 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17957 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17958
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017959sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17960sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17961sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17962sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17963 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17964 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17965
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017966sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017967sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17968sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17969sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017970 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
17971 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17972 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017973 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17974 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17975 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017976
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017977sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17978sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17979sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17980sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17981 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17982 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17983 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17984 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17985 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17986 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17987
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017988sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017989sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17990sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17991sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017992 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017993 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
17994 See also src_http_err_cnt.
17995
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017996sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017997sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17998sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17999sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018000 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
18001 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18002 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
18003 src_http_err_rate.
18004
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018005sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18006sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18007sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18008sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18009 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
18010 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
18011 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
18012
18013sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18014sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18015sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18016sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18017 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
18018 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
18019 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
18020 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
18021
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018022sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018023sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18024sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18025sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018026 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018027 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18028 src_http_req_cnt.
18029
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018030sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018031sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18032sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18033sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018034 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
18035 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
18036 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18037 src_http_req_rate.
18038
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018039sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018040sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18041sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18042sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018043 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018044 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18045 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18046 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18047 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018048
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018049 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018050 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18051 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018052 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18053
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018054sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18055sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18056sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18057sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18058 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
18059 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18060 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18061 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18062 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
18063
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018064sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018065sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18066sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18067sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018068 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
18069 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18070 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018071
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018072sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018073sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18074sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18075sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018076 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
18077 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18078 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018079
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018080sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018081sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18082sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18083sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018084 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018085 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
18086 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
18087 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018088 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018089 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
18090
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018091sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018092sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18093sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18094sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018095 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
18096 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18097 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
18098 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
18099 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018100 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018101
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018102sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018103sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18104sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18105sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020018106 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
18107 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
18108 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
18109
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018110sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018111sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18112sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18113sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018114 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18115 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018116 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018117 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
18118 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018119 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18120 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18121 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018123so_id : integer
18124 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18125 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18126 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018127
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018128so_name : string
18129 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18130 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18131 strings instead of integers.
18132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018133src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018134 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018135 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
18136 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
18137 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018138 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
18139 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
18140 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010018141 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
18142 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18143 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18144 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18145 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18146 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18147 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018148
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018149 Example:
18150 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18151 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018153src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18154 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18155 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18156 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018157 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018159src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18160 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18161 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018162 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018163 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018165src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18166 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18167 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18168 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18169 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18170 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18171 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018172
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018173 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018174 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18175 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18176 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18177 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018178 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018179 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18180 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18181
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018182src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18183 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18184 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18185 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18186 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18187 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18188 was verified.
18189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018190src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018191 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018192 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018193 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018194 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018196src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018197 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018198 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18199 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018200 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018202src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18203 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18204 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18205 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018206 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018208src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018209 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018210 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018211 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018212 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018213
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018214src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18215 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18216 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18217 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18218 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18219
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018220src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18221 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18222 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18223 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18224 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018226src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018227 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018228 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018229 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18230 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018231 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18232 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18233 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018234
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018235src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18236 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18237 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18238 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18239 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18240 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18241 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18242 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018244src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018245 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018246 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018247 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018248 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018249 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018251src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18252 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18253 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18254 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18255 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018256 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018257
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018258src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18259 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18260 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018261 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018262 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18263 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18264
18265src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18266 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18267 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18268 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18269 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18270 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18271 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018273src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018274 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018275 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18276 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018277 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018279src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18280 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18281 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18282 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018283 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018284 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018286src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18287 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18288 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18289 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018290 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018291 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18292 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018293
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018294 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018295 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018296 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018297 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018298
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018299src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18300 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18301 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18302 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18303 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18304 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18305 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18306
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018307src_is_local : boolean
18308 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18309 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18310 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18311 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018312 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018313 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18314 once per connection.
18315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018316src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018317 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18318 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18319 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18320 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18321 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018323src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018324 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18325 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18326 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18327 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18328 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018330src_port : integer
18331 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18332 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18333 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18334 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018336src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018337 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018338 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18339 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18340 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018341 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018343src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18344 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18345 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18346 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18347 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018348 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018350src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18351 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18352 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18353 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18354 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18355 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18356 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18357 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18358 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018359
18360 Example :
18361 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18362 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18363 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18364 listen ssh
18365 bind :22
18366 mode tcp
18367 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018368 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018369 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018370 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018372srv_id : integer
18373 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18374 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018375 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018376
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018377srv_name : string
18378 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18379 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018380 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018381
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200183827.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018383----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018384
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018385The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018386closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18387when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18388usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018389future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018390
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001839151d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18392 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18393 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18394 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18395 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18396 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18397
18398 Example :
18399 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18400 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18401 # the request.
18402 frontend http-in
18403 bind *:8081
18404 default_backend servers
18405 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18406 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18407
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018408ssl_bc : boolean
18409 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18410 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018411 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18412 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018413
18414ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18415 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018416 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18417 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018418
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018419ssl_bc_alpn : string
18420 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18421 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018422 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018423 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18424 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18425 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18426 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18427 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018428 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18429 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018430
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018431ssl_bc_cipher : string
18432 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018433 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18434 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018435
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018436ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18437 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18438 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18439 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018440 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018441
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018442ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18443 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18444 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018445 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18446 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018447
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018448ssl_bc_npn : string
18449 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18450 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018451 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018452 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18453 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18454 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18455 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018456 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18457 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018458
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018459ssl_bc_protocol : string
18460 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018461 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18462 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018463
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018464ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018465 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018466 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018467 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18468 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018469
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018470ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18471 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18472 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18473 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018474 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018475
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018476ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18477 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18478 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018479 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18480 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018481
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018482ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18483 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18484 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18485 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018486 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018487
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018488ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18489 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018490 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18491 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018493ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18494 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18495 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18496 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18497 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18498 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018500ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18501 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18502 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18503 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18504 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018505
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018506ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018507 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18508 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18509 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018510 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018511 does not support resumed sessions.
18512
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018513ssl_c_der : binary
18514 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18515 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18516 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018518ssl_c_err : integer
18519 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18520 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18521 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18522 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18523 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018524
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018525ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018526 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18527 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18528 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18529 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18530 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18531 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18532 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18533 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018534 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18535 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18536 LDAP v3.
18537 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18538 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018540ssl_c_key_alg : string
18541 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18542 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18543 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018545ssl_c_notafter : string
18546 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18547 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18548 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018550ssl_c_notbefore : string
18551 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18552 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18553 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018554
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018555ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018556 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18557 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18558 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18559 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18560 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18561 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18562 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18563 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018564 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18565 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18566 LDAP v3.
18567 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18568 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018570ssl_c_serial : binary
18571 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18572 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18573 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018575ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18576 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18577 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18578 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018579 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18580 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18581
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018582 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018583 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018585ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18586 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18587 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18588 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018590ssl_c_used : boolean
18591 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18592 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018594ssl_c_verify : integer
18595 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18596 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18597 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18598 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018600ssl_c_version : integer
18601 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18602 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018603
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018604ssl_f_der : binary
18605 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18606 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18607 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18608
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018609ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018610 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18611 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18612 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18613 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018614 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018615 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18616 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18617 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018618 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18619 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18620 LDAP v3.
18621 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18622 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018624ssl_f_key_alg : string
18625 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18626 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18627 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018629ssl_f_notafter : string
18630 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18631 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18632 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018634ssl_f_notbefore : string
18635 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18636 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18637 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018638
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018639ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018640 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18641 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18642 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18643 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18644 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18645 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18646 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18647 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018648 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18649 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18650 LDAP v3.
18651 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18652 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018654ssl_f_serial : binary
18655 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18656 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18657 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018658
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018659ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18660 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18661 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18662 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018664ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18665 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18666 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18667 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018669ssl_f_version : integer
18670 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18671 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18672
18673ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018674 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18675 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18676 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018678 Example :
18679 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18680 listen http-https
18681 bind :80
18682 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18683 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18684
18685ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18686 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18687 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18688
18689ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018690 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018691 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018692 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018693 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18694 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18695 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18696 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18697 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18698 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018700ssl_fc_cipher : string
18701 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18702 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018703
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018704ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18705 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18706 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018707 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018708
18709ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18710 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18711 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018712 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018713
18714ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18715 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18716 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18717 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018718 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018719 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018720
18721ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18722 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18723 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018724 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018725
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018726ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18727 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18728 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18729 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18730
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018731ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18732 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18733 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18734 transport layer.
18735 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18736 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18737 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18738 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18739
18740ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18741 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18742 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18743 transport layer.
18744 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18745 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18746 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18747 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18748
18749ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18750 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18751 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18752 transport layer.
18753 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18754 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18755 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18756 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18757
18758ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18759 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18760 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18761 transport layer.
18762 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18763 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18764 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18765 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18766
18767ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18768 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18769 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18770 transport layer.
18771 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18772 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18773 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18774 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018776ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018777 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18778 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018779 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18780 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18781 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18782 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018783
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018784ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18785 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18786 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18787 wait until the handshake happened.
18788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018789ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18790 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018791 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18792 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018793 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018794 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018795
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018796ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018797 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018798 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18799 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018801ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018802 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018803 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018804 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18805 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18806 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18807 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18808 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18809 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018811ssl_fc_protocol : string
18812 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18813 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018814
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018815ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018816 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018817 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletc5de4192021-11-09 14:23:36 +010018818 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018819
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018820ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18821 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18822 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18823 transport layer.
18824 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18825 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18826 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18827 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18828
18829ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18830 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18831 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18832 transport layer.
18833 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18834 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18835 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18836 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18837
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018838ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18839 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18840 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18841 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018843ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18844 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18845 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18846 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18847 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018848
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018849ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18850 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18851 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18852 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18853 BoringSSL.
18854
18855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018856ssl_fc_sni : string
18857 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18858 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018859 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018860 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18861 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18862
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020018863 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018864 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018865 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018866 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018867 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018869 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018870 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18871 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018873ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18874 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18875 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018876
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018877ssl_s_der : binary
18878 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18879 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18880 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18881
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018882ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18883 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18884 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18885 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018886 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018887 does not support resumed sessions.
18888
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018889ssl_s_key_alg : string
18890 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18891 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
18892 SSL/TLS transport layer.
18893
18894ssl_s_notafter : string
18895 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
18896 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18897 transport layer.
18898
18899ssl_s_notbefore : string
18900 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
18901 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18902 transport layer.
18903
18904ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18905 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18906 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18907 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18908 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18909 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18910 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018911 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18912 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018913 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18914 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18915 LDAP v3.
18916 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18917 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18918
18919ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18920 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18921 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18922 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18923 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18924 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18925 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018926 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18927 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018928 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18929 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18930 LDAP v3.
18931 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18932 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18933
18934ssl_s_serial : binary
18935 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
18936 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18937 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18938
18939ssl_s_sha1 : binary
18940 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
18941 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18942 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18943
18944ssl_s_sig_alg : string
18945 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18946 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18947 layer.
18948
18949ssl_s_version : integer
18950 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
18951 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018952
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200189537.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018954------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018956Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
18957sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
18958only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
18959For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
18960be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
18961can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
18962sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
18963for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
18964content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018965
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010018966Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
18967 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018968 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010018969 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
18970 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
18971 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
18972 sample expression). So be careful.
18973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018974payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018975 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018976 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
18977 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018979payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
18980 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018981 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018982 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018984req.len : integer
18985req_len : integer (deprecated)
18986 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18987 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18988 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18989 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18990 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018991 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018992 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
18993 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018995req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18996 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018997 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
18998 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
18999 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
19000 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019001
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019002 ACL derivatives :
19003 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019005req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19006 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19007 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19008 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
19009 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019010
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019011 ACL derivatives :
19012 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019014 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019016req.proto_http : boolean
19017req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
19018 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
19019 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
19020 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
19021 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
19022 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
19023 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
19024 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019026 Example:
19027 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
19028 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19029 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019030 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019032req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
19033rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19034 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
19035 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
19036 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
19037 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
19038 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
19039 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
19040 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019042 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
19043 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
19044 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
19045 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
19046 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
19047 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019049 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019050 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019052 Example :
19053 listen tse-farm
19054 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
19055 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
19056 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19057 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
19058 # apply RDP cookie persistence
19059 persist rdp-cookie
19060 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
19061 # This is only useful makes sense if
19062 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
19063 stick-table type string size 204800
19064 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
19065 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
19066 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019068 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019069 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019071req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
19072rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
19073 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
19074 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
19075 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
19076 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019078 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019079 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019080
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019081req.ssl_alpn : string
19082 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
19083 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
19084 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
19085 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
19086 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
19087 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019088 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019089
19090 Examples :
19091 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19092 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019093 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019094 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019095 default_backend bk_default
19096
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019097req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
19098 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
19099 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020019100 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
19101 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
19102 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
19103 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
19104 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019106req.ssl_hello_type : integer
19107req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19108 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19109 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
19110 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19111 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19112 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
19113 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19114 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019116req.ssl_sni : string
19117req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
19118 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
19119 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
19120 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
19121 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19122 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020019123 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
19124 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
19125 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
19126 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
19127 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
19128 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
19129 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
19130 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
19131 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019133 ACL derivatives :
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019134 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019136 Examples :
19137 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19138 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019139 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019140 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019141 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019142
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053019143req.ssl_st_ext : integer
19144 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
19145 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
19146 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
19147 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
19148 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
19149 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
19150 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
19151 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
19152 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
19153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019154req.ssl_ver : integer
19155req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
19156 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
19157 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
19158 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
19159 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
19160 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19161 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
19162 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019163 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019164 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019166 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019167 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019168
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019169res.len : integer
19170 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19171 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19172 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19173 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19174 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019175 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019176 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019177 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019179res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19180 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019181 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019182 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019183 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019184 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019186res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19187 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19188 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19189 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019190 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19191 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019193 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019194
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019195res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19196rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19197 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19198 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19199 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19200 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19201 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19202 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19203 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019205wait_end : boolean
19206 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19207 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019208 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019209 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19210 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019211 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019212 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19213 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019215 Examples :
19216 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19217 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19218 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019220 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19221 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19222 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19223 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19224 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19225 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19226 tcp-request content reject
19227
19228
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200192297.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019230--------------------------------------
19231
19232It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19233This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19234data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19235its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19236HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19237content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19238to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19239more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19240response are indexed.
19241
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019242Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19243 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19244 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19245 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19246 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19247 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19248 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019250base : string
19251 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19252 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19253 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19254 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19255 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19256 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19257 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19258 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19259
19260 ACL derivatives :
19261 base : exact string match
19262 base_beg : prefix match
19263 base_dir : subdir match
19264 base_dom : domain match
19265 base_end : suffix match
19266 base_len : length match
19267 base_reg : regex match
19268 base_sub : substring match
19269
19270base32 : integer
19271 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19272 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19273 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019274 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19275 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19276 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019277
19278base32+src : binary
19279 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19280 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19281 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19282 per-URL counters.
19283
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019284baseq : string
19285 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19286 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19287 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19288 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19289
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019290capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19291 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19292 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19293 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19294
19295capture.req.method : string
19296 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19297 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19298 because it's allocated.
19299
19300capture.req.uri : string
19301 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19302 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19303 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19304 allocated.
19305
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019306capture.req.ver : string
19307 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19308 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19309 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19310
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019311capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19312 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19313 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19314 The first entry is an index of 0.
19315 See also: "capture response header"
19316
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019317capture.res.ver : string
19318 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19319 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19320 persistent flag.
19321
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019322req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019323 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19324 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19325 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019326
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019327req.body_param([<name>) : string
19328 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19329 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19330 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19331 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19332 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19333 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19334 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19335 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19336 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19337 given.
19338
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019339req.body_len : integer
19340 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19341 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019342 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19343 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019344
19345req.body_size : integer
19346 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019347 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19348 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019350req.cook([<name>]) : string
19351cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19352 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19353 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19354 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19355 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19356 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19357 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19358 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19359 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19360
19361 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019362 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19363 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19364 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19365 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19366 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19367 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19368 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19369 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019371req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19372cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19373 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19374 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019376req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19377cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19378 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19379 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19380 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19381 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019383cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19384 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19385 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19386 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19387 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019388 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019389 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19390 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19391 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19392 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019394hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19395 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19396 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19397 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19398 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019399 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019401req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019402 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19403 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19404 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19405 with headers such as User-Agent.
19406
19407 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19408 found.
19409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019410 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19411 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19412 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019413 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019415req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19416 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19417 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019418 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19419 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019421req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019422 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19423 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19424 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19425 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19426 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19427 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19428 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19429
19430 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19431 found.
19432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019433 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19434 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19435 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019436 with -1 being the last one.
19437
19438 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19439 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019441 ACL derivatives :
19442 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19443 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19444 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19445 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19446 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19447 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19448 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19449 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19450
19451req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19452hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19453 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19454 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019455 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19456 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19457 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19458
19459 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19460 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19461 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19462
19463 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019464
19465req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19466hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19467 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19468 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19469 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019470 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19471 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19472 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19473 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19474 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019475
19476 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19477
19478 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019479
19480req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19481hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19482 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19483 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19484 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019485
19486 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19487
19488 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019489
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019490req.hdrs : string
19491 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19492 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19493 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19494 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19495
19496req.hdrs_bin : binary
19497 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19498 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19499 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19500 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19501 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19502 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19503
19504 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019505
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019506 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19507 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019509http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19510 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19511 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19512 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19513 basic auth is supported.
19514
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019515http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19516 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19517 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19518 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19519 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019520 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19521 basic auth is supported.
19522
19523 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019524 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19525 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19526 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19527 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019528
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019529http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019530 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19531 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19532 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019533
19534http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019535 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19536 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19537 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019538
19539http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019540 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19541 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19542 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019544http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019545 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19546 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019547 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19548 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019550method : integer + string
19551 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19552 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19553 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19554 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19555 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19556 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19557 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019559 ACL derivatives :
19560 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019562 Example :
19563 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19564 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19565 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019567path : string
19568 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19569 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19570 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19571 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19572 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019573 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019574 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019576 ACL derivatives :
19577 path : exact string match
19578 path_beg : prefix match
19579 path_dir : subdir match
19580 path_dom : domain match
19581 path_end : suffix match
19582 path_len : length match
19583 path_reg : regex match
19584 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019585
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019586pathq : string
19587 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19588 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19589 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19590 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19591 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19592 result in both cases.
19593
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019594query : string
19595 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19596 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19597 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19598 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019599 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019600 which stops before the question mark.
19601
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019602req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19603 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19604 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19605 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19606 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019608req.ver : string
19609req_ver : string (deprecated)
19610 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19611 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19612 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019614 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019615 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019616
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019617res.body : binary
19618 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19619 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019620 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19621
19622 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019623
19624res.body_len : integer
19625 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19626 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019627 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19628
19629 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019630
19631res.body_size : integer
19632 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19633 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19634 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19635 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019636 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19637
19638 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019639
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019640res.cache_hit : boolean
19641 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19642 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19643
19644res.cache_name : string
19645 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19646 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19647 empty string.
19648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019649res.comp : boolean
19650 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19651 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19652 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019654res.comp_algo : string
19655 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19656 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19657 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019659res.cook([<name>]) : string
19660scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19661 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19662 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019663 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19664
19665 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019667 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019668 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019670res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19671scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19672 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19673 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019674 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19675
19676 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019678res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19679scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19680 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19681 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019682 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19683
19684 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019686res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019687 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19688 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19689
19690 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19691 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19692
19693 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19694
19695 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019697res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019698 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19699 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19700
19701 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19702 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19703
19704 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019706res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19707shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019708 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19709 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19710
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019711 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019712 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19713
19714 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019716 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019717 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19718 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19719 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19720 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19721 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19722 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19723 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19724 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019725
19726res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19727shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019728 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19729 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19730
19731 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019732 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019733
19734 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019736res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19737shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019738 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19739 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19740
19741 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19742
19743 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019744
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019745res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19746 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19747 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19748 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019749 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19750
19751 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019753res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19754shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019755 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19756 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19757
19758 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19759
19760 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019761
19762res.hdrs : string
19763 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19764 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19765 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019766 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19767
19768 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019769
19770res.hdrs_bin : binary
19771 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19772 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19773 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19774 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19775 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19776 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19777 (length of 0 for both).
19778
19779 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19780
19781 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19782 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019784res.ver : string
19785resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19786 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019787 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19788
19789 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019791 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019792 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019794set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19795 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19796 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019797 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019798 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019800 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19801 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019803status : integer
19804 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19805 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019806 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19807
19808 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019809
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019810unique-id : string
19811 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19812 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19813 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19814 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19815 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19816 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019818url : string
19819 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19820 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19821 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19822 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19823 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19824 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
19825 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019827 ACL derivatives :
19828 url : exact string match
19829 url_beg : prefix match
19830 url_dir : subdir match
19831 url_dom : domain match
19832 url_end : suffix match
19833 url_len : length match
19834 url_reg : regex match
19835 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019837url_ip : ip
19838 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19839 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19840 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19841 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19842 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19843 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19844 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019846url_port : integer
19847 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19848 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19849 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19850 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019851
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019852urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19853url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019854 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19855 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019856 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19857 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19858 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19859 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019860 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19861 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019862 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19863 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019865 ACL derivatives :
19866 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19867 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19868 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19869 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19870 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19871 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19872 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19873 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019874
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019876 Example :
19877 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
19878 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
19879 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
19880 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019881
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019882urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019883 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
19884 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
19885 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020019886
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020019887url32 : integer
19888 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
19889 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
19890 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
19891 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
19892 is an unsigned integer.
19893
19894url32+src : binary
19895 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
19896 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
19897 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
19898
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020019899
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200199007.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019901---------------------------------------
19902
19903This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
19904used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
19905purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
19906There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
19907or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
19908any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
19909for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
19910
19911internal.htx.data : integer
19912 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
19913 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19914
19915internal.htx.free : integer
19916 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
19917 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19918
19919internal.htx.free_data : integer
19920 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
19921 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19922
19923internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010019924 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
19925 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
19926 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019927
19928internal.htx.nbblks : integer
19929 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
19930 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19931
19932internal.htx.size : integer
19933 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
19934 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19935
19936internal.htx.used : integer
19937 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
19938 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19939 direction.
19940
19941internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
19942 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19943 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
19944 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
19945 of the special value :
19946 * head : The oldest inserted block
19947 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019948 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019949
19950internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
19951 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19952 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
19953 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
19954 integer or one of the special value :
19955 * head : The oldest inserted block
19956 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019957 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019958
19959internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
19960 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19961 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
19962 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19963 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19964
19965 * head : The oldest inserted block
19966 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019967 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019968
19969internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
19970 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19971 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19972 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19973 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19974
19975 * head : The oldest inserted block
19976 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019977 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019978
19979internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
19980 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19981 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19982 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19983 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19984
19985 * head : The oldest inserted block
19986 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019987 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019988
19989internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
19990 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
19991 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
19992 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19993 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19994
19995 * head : The oldest inserted block
19996 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019997 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019998
19999internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
20000 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
20001 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
20002 it returns false.
20003
20004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200200057.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020006---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020007
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020008Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
20009every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020020010order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020011
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020012ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020013---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
20014FALSE always_false never match
20015HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
20016HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
20017HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010020018HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020019HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
20020HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
20021HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
20022HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
20023LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
20024METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
20025METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
20026METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
20027METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
20028METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
20029METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
20030METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
20031METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
20032RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
20033REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
20034TRUE always_true always match
20035WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
20036---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020037
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010020038
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200398. Logging
20040----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020041
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020042One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
20043provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
20044very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
20045provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
20046state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020047to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020048headers.
20049
20050In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
20051about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
20052send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
20053
20054 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
20055 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
20056 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
20057 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
20058 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020059 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060020060 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020061
20062The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
20063allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
20064as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
20065while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
20066real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
20067delay.
20068
20069
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200708.1. Log levels
20071---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020072
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020073TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020074source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020075HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
20076in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
20077track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
20078syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
20079about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020080
20081
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200828.2. Log formats
20083----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020084
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020085HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020086and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
20087slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
20088options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020089
20090 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
20091 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
20092 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
20093 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
20094 extents.
20095
20096 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
20097 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
20098 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
20099 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
20100 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
20101
20102 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
20103 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
20104 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
20105 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
20106 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
20107
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020020108 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
20109 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
20110 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
20111 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
20112
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020113 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
20114
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020115Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
20116specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
20117field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
20118servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
20119always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
20120identifier.
20121
20122Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
20123 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
20124 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
20125 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
20126 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
20127
20128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201298.2.1. Default log format
20130-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020131
20132This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
20133as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
20134format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
20135
20136 Example :
20137 listen www
20138 mode http
20139 log global
20140 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20141
20142 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
20143 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
20144 (www/HTTP)
20145
20146 Field Format Extract from the example above
20147 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
20148 2 'Connect from' Connect from
20149 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
20150 4 'to' to
20151 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
20152 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
20153
20154Detailed fields description :
20155 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
20156 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
20157 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
20158 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
20159 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20160 and processed the connection.
20161 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
20162
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020163In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
20164"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
20165connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
20166
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020167It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
20168will eventually disappear.
20169
20170
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201718.2.2. TCP log format
20172---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020173
20174The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20175is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20176information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20177counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20178emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20179environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20180the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20181sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020182specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
20183not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
20184fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
20185marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020186
20187 Example :
20188 frontend fnt
20189 mode tcp
20190 option tcplog
20191 log global
20192 default_backend bck
20193
20194 backend bck
20195 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20196
20197 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20198 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20199 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20200
20201 Field Format Extract from the example above
20202 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20203 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20204 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20205 4 frontend_name fnt
20206 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20207 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20208 7 bytes_read* 212
20209 8 termination_state --
20210 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20211 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20212
20213Detailed fields description :
20214 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020215 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020216 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20217 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020218 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020219 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020220 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020221
20222 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020223 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20224 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20225 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020226
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020227 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020228 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20229 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020230 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20231 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20232 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20233 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020234
20235 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20236 and processed the connection.
20237
20238 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20239 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20240 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20241 applications.
20242
20243 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20244 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20245 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20246 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20247 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20248
20249 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20250 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20251 See "Timers" below for more details.
20252
20253 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20254 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20255 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20256 "Timers" below for more details.
20257
20258 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020259 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020260 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20261 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20262 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20263 details.
20264
20265 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20266 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20267 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20268 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20269 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20270
20271 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20272 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20273 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20274 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20275 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20276 for more details.
20277
20278 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020279 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020280 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20281 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20282 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020283 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020284
20285 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20286 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20287 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20288 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20289 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20290 caused by a denial of service attack.
20291
20292 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20293 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20294 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20295 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20296 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20297 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20298 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20299 denial of service attack.
20300
20301 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20302 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20303 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20304 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20305 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20306 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20307 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20308 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20309 be processed than on other servers.
20310
20311 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20312 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20313 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20314 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020315 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020316 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20317 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20318 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20319 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20320 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20321 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20322 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20323 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20324
20325 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20326 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20327 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20328 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20329 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20330 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020331 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020332 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20333
20334 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20335 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20336 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20337 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20338 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20339 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020340 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020341 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20342 occurs.
20343
20344
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203458.2.3. HTTP log format
20346----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020347
20348The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20349is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20350the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20351are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20352emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20353generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20354"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20355which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020356frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20357is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020358
20359Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20360slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20361with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20362
20363 Example :
20364 frontend http-in
20365 mode http
20366 option httplog
20367 log global
20368 default_backend bck
20369
20370 backend static
20371 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20372
20373 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20374 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20375 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020376 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020377
20378 Field Format Extract from the example above
20379 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20380 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020381 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020382 4 frontend_name http-in
20383 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020384 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020385 7 status_code 200
20386 8 bytes_read* 2750
20387 9 captured_request_cookie -
20388 10 captured_response_cookie -
20389 11 termination_state ----
20390 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20391 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20392 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20393 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20394 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020395
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020396Detailed fields description :
20397 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020398 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020399 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20400 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020401 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020402 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020403 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020404
20405 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020406 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20407 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20408 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020409
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020410 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020411 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020412
20413 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20414 and processed the connection.
20415
20416 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20417 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20418 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20419
20420 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20421 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20422 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20423 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20424 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20425 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20426
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020427 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20428 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20429 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020430 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020431 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20432 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020433 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020434 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020435
20436 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20437 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020438 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020439
20440 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20441 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020442 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20443 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020444
20445 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20446 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20447 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20448 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20449 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020450 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20451 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020452
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020453 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020454 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20455 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20456 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20457 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20458 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20459 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020460 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020461
20462 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020463 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
20464 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020465
20466 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20467 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020468 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020469 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20470 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20471 overflowing.
20472
20473 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20474 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20475 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20476 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20477 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20478 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20479 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20480 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20481
20482 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20483 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20484 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20485 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20486 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20487 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20488 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20489 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20490
20491 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20492 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20493 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20494 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20495 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20496 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20497 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20498
20499 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020500 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020501 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20502 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20503 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020504 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020505 system.
20506
20507 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20508 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20509 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20510 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20511 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20512 caused by a denial of service attack.
20513
20514 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20515 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20516 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20517 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20518 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20519 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20520 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20521 denial of service attack.
20522
20523 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20524 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20525 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20526 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20527 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20528 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20529 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20530 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20531 processed than on other servers.
20532
20533 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20534 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20535 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20536 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020537 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020538 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20539 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20540 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20541 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20542 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20543 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20544 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20545 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20546
20547 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20548 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20549 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20550 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20551 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20552 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020553 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020554 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20555
20556 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20557 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20558 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20559 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20560 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20561 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020562 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020563 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20564 occurs.
20565
20566 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20567 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20568 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20569 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20570 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20571 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20572 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20573 cookies" below for more details.
20574
20575 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20576 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20577 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20578 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20579 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20580 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20581 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20582 and cookies" below for more details.
20583
20584 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20585 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20586 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20587 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20588 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20589 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20590 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20591 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20592
20593
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200205948.2.4. Custom log format
20595------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020596
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020597The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020598mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020599
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020600HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020601Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20602separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20603prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20604
20605Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20606variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020607("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020608
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020609If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020610as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020611less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20612the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20613
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020614Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20615"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20616delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20617preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020618
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020619Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20620'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20621https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20622such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20623
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020624Flags are :
20625 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020626 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020627 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20628 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020629
20630 Example:
20631
20632 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20633 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20634
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020635 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20636
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020637At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20638
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020639 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20640 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020641
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020642the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020643
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020644 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20645 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20646 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020647
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020648and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20649
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020650 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20651 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020652
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020653Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20654
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020655 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020656 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020657 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20658 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20659 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020660 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20661 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20662 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020663 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020664 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020665 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020666 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020667 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020668 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20669 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020670 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020671 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020672 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3f177162021-12-03 10:48:36 +010020673 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020674 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020675 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020676 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020677 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20678 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20679 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20680 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20681 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020682 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020683 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020684 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020685 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020686 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020687 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20688 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020689 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20690 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20691 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020692 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020693 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20694 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020695 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020696 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20697 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20698 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020699 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020700 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020701 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20702 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20703 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20704 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020705 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020706 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020707 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020708 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020709 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020710 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020711 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20712 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20713 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020714 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020715 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20716 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020717 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020718 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20719 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020720 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020721 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020722 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020723 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020724
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020725 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020726
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020727
207288.2.5. Error log format
20729-----------------------
20730
20731When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020732protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020733By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20734"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020735will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020736logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20737
20738The format looks like this :
20739
20740 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20741 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20742 Connection error during SSL handshake
20743
20744 Field Format Extract from the example above
20745 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20746 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20747 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20748 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20749 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20750
20751These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20752failures.
20753
20754
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207558.3. Advanced logging options
20756-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020757
20758Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20759just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20760options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20761for more information about their usage.
20762
20763
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207648.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20765------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020766
20767It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020768HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020769commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20770monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20771ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20772
20773 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20774 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20775 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20776 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20777
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020778 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20779 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020780
20781 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20782 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20783 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20784
20785
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207868.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20787----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020788
20789The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20790what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20791or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020792"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020793just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20794log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20795after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20796is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20797with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20798with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20799
20800
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208018.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20802------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020803
20804Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20805for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20806"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20807retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20808raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20809a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20810file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20811you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20812"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20813
20814
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208158.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20816--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020817
20818Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20819multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20820them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20821"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20822logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20823error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20824and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20825too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20826useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20827alternative.
20828
20829
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208308.4. Timing events
20831------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020832
20833Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20834reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20835the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20836frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020837mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20838addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20839
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020840Timings events in HTTP mode:
20841
20842 first request 2nd request
20843 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20844 t tr t tr ...
20845 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20846 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20847 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20848 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020849 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020850 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20851
20852Timings events in TCP mode:
20853
20854 TCP session
20855 |<----------------->|
20856 t t
20857 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20858 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20859 |<------ Tt ------->|
20860
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020861 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020862 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020863 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20864 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20865 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020866 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020867 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20868 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20869 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20870 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020871
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020872 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20873 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20874 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020875 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20876 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20877 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
20878 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
20879 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
20880 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020881
20882 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
20883 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
20884 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
20885 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
20886 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
20887 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
20888 request typed by hand during a test.
20889
20890 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
20891 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020892 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020893 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
20894 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
20895 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
20896 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020897
20898 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
20899 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
20900 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
20901 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
20902 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
20903
20904 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
20905 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
20906 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
20907 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
20908 connection never established.
20909
20910 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
20911 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
20912 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
20913 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
20914 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
20915 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
20916 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
20917 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
20918 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
20919 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
20920 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
20921
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020922 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
20923 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
20924 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
20925 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
20926 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
20927 by subtracting other timers when valid :
20928
20929 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
20930
20931 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
20932 "Ta" can never be negative.
20933
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020934 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
20935 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020936 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
20937 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020938 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020939
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020940 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020941
20942 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020943 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
20944 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020945
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020946 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
20947 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
20948 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
20949 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
20950 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
20951 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
20952 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
20953 prefixed with a '+' sign.
20954
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020955These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
20956protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
20957that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020958due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
20959"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
20960that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020961
20962Most common cases :
20963
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020964 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
20965 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
20966 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
20967 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
20968 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020969 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020970 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
20971 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
20972 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
20973 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
20974 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020020975 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020976
20977 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
20978 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
20979 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
20980 of ms on remote networks.
20981
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020982 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
20983 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
20984 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020985
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020986 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
20987 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020988 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020989 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
20990 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
20991 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
20992 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
20993 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
20994 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020995
20996Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
20997
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020998 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020999 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021000 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021001
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021002 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021003 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
21004 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
21005
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021006 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021007 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
21008 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
21009 flags.
21010
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021011 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
21012 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021013 Check the session termination flags, then check the
21014 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
21015 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
21016 the client connection was maintained open.
21017
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021018 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021019 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021020 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021021 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
21022
21023
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210248.5. Session state at disconnection
21025-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021026
21027TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
21028"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
210292-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
21030each of which has a special meaning :
21031
21032 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
21033 session to terminate :
21034
21035 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
21036
21037 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
21038 server explicitly refused it.
21039
21040 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
21041 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
21042 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
21043 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021044 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021045
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021046 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021047 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021048
21049 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
21050 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
21051 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
21052 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
21053 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
21054
21055 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
21056 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
21057 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
21058 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
21059 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
21060
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021061 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090021062 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
21063
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021064 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070021065 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
21066 backup connections when going up.
21067
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021068 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020021069
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021070 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
21071 send or receive data.
21072
21073 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
21074 send or receive data.
21075
21076 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
21077 with nothing left in the buffers.
21078
21079 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
21080
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010021081 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021082 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
21083
21084 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
21085 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
21086 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
21087 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
21088 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
21089
21090 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
21091 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
21092
21093 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
21094 server (HTTP only).
21095
21096 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
21097
21098 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
21099 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
21100 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
21101
21102 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
21103 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
21104 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
21105
21106 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
21107
21108 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
21109 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
21110
21111 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
21112 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
21113 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
21114
21115 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
21116 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020021117 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
21118 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021119
21120 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
21121 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
21122 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
21123 another server.
21124
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021125 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021126 server.
21127
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021128 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
21129 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
21130 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
21131 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21132
21133 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
21134 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
21135 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
21136 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21137
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020021138 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
21139 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
21140 "use-server" rule).
21141
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021142 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21143
21144 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
21145 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
21146
21147 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
21148
21149 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
21150 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
21151 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
21152
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021153 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
21154 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021155 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021156 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
21157 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
21158
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021159 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
21160
21161 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
21162 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
21163
21164 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
21165
21166 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21167
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021168The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
21169was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021170helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
21171starvation, attacks, etc...
21172
21173The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
21174alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
21175easier finding and understanding.
21176
21177 Flags Reason
21178
21179 -- Normal termination.
21180
21181 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021182 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
21183 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021184 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
21185
21186 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
21187 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021188 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
21189 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021190 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
21191 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021192
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021193 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21194 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021195 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021196
21197 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
21198 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
21199 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
21200
21201 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
21202 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
21203 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
21204 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
21205 the server takes too long to respond.
21206
21207 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21208 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21209 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21210 long a time to respond.
21211
21212 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21213 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21214 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021215 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021216 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21217 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021218
21219 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21220 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21221 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21222 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21223 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021224 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021225 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21226 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21227 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21228 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21229 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21230 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21231 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21232 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021233 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021234 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21235 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21236 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021237
21238 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21239 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021240 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21241 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21242 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21243 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021244
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021245 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021246 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
21247
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021248 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021249 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21250 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021251 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021252 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21253 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21254
21255 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21256 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21257 503 or 504 here.
21258
21259 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021260 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021261 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21262 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21263 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21264
21265 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21266 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021267 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021268 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021269 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021270
21271 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21272 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21273 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21274 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21275 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21276 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021277 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021278
21279 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21280 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21281 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21282 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21283 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21284 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21285 solution is to fix the application.
21286
21287 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21288 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21289 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21290 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21291 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21292 external attacks.
21293
21294 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021295 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021296 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021297 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21298 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21299
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021300 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21301 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21302 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021303 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021304 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021305
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021306 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21307 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21308 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21309 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021310 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21311 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21312 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21313 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
Christopher Fauletae72ae42022-05-05 12:27:07 +020021314 logs. Finally, it may be due to an HTTP header rewrite failure on the
21315 response. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is sent (see
21316 "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-response strict-mode" for more
21317 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021318
21319 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21320 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21321 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
Christopher Fauletae72ae42022-05-05 12:27:07 +020021322 returned an HTTP 403 error. It may also be due to an HTTP header
21323 rewrite failure on the request. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is
21324 sent (see "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-request strict-mode" for more
21325 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021326
21327 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21328 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21329 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21330 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21331
21332 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21333 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21334 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21335 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21336
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021337The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021338persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021339important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21340re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21341
21342 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21343
21344 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21345 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21346 set on a GET request.
21347
21348 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21349 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021350 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021351 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21352
21353 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21354 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21355 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21356
21357 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21358 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21359 already got a cookie.
21360
21361 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21362 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21363 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21364 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21365 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21366
21367 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21368 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21369 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21370
21371 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21372 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21373 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21374
21375 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21376 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21377
21378 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21379 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21380 then advertised in the response.
21381
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021382
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213838.6. Non-printable characters
21384-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021385
21386In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21387consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21388converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21389prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21390being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21391escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21392is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21393'}' when logging headers.
21394
21395Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21396issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21397containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21398
21399Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21400the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21401performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21402
21403
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214048.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21405---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021406
21407Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21408achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021409section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021410cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21411the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21412the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021413locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021414not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21415user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21416a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21417wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21418
21419 Examples :
21420 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21421 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21422
21423 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21424 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21425
21426
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214278.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21428---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021429
21430Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21431proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21432the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21433server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21434
21435Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21436response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021437section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021438
21439It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021440time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21441appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021442are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21443and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21444follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21445request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21446in the logs.
21447
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021448As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21449frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21450an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21451
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021452 Example :
21453 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21454 listen proxy-out
21455 mode http
21456 option httplog
21457 option logasap
21458 log global
21459 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21460
21461 # log the name of the virtual server
21462 capture request header Host len 20
21463
21464 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21465 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21466
21467 # log the beginning of the referrer
21468 capture request header Referer len 20
21469
21470 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21471 capture response header Server len 20
21472
21473 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21474 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21475
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021476 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021477 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21478
21479 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21480 capture response header Via len 20
21481
21482 # log the URL location during a redirection
21483 capture response header Location len 20
21484
21485 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21486 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21487 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21488 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21489 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21490
21491 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21492 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21493 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21494 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021495 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021496
21497 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21498 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21499 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21500 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21501 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021502 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021503
21504
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215058.9. Examples of logs
21506---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021507
21508These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21509them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21510reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21511
21512 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21513 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21514 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21515
21516 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21517 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21518
21519 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21520 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21521 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21522
21523 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21524 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21525
21526 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21527 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21528 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21529
21530 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021531 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021532 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21533 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21534
21535 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21536 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21537 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21538
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021539 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21540 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21541 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21542 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021543 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021544 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021545
21546 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021547 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021548
21549 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21550 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21551 Nothing was sent to any server.
21552
21553 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21554 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21555
21556 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21557 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021558 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021559 send a 408 return code to the client.
21560
21561 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21562 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21563
21564 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21565 5 seconds ("c----").
21566
21567 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21568 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021569 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021570
21571 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021572 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021573 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21574 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21575 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21576 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21577 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021578
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021579
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200215809. Supported filters
21581--------------------
21582
21583Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21584accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21585unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21586
21587See also : "filter"
21588
215899.1. Trace
21590----------
21591
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021592filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021593
21594 Arguments:
21595 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21596 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21597
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021598 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021599
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021600 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021601 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21602 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21603 amount of the parsed data.
21604
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021605 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021606
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021607This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21608callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21609information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21610filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21611
21612Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21613tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21614a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21615
21616
216179.2. HTTP compression
21618---------------------
21619
21620filter compression
21621
21622The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21623keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021624when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21625fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21626done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21627explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21628filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21629listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21630order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021631
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021632See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21633 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021634
21635
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200216369.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21637--------------------------------------------
21638
21639filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21640
21641 Arguments :
21642
21643 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21644 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21645 parsed.
21646
21647 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21648 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21649 part must be placed in its own scope.
21650
21651The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21652external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021653streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021654exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21655also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21656
21657SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21658the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21659
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021660For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021661"doc/SPOE.txt".
21662
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100216639.4. Cache
21664----------
21665
21666filter cache <name>
21667
21668 Arguments :
21669
21670 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21671
21672The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21673"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021674cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021675other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21676case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21677is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21678filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021679listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21680order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021681
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021682See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21683 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21684
21685
216869.5. Fcgi-app
21687-------------
21688
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021689filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021690
21691 Arguments :
21692
21693 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21694
21695The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21696request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21697reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21698used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21699implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21700used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21701fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21702used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21703order.
21704
21705See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21706 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21707
21708
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100217099.6. OpenTracing
21710----------------
21711
21712The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21713HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21714of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21715Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21716
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021717This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021718
21719The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21720HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21721participates in the work of HAProxy.
21722
21723filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21724
21725 Arguments :
21726
21727 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21728 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21729 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21730 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21731 OpenTracing filters.
21732
21733 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21734 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21735 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21736 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21737 filter must have its own scope defined.
21738
21739More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020021740of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021741
21742
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002174310. FastCGI applications
21744-------------------------
21745
21746HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21747feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21748the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21749FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21750servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21751FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21752backend.
21753
21754HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21755application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21756connection.
21757
2175810.1. Setup
21759-----------
21760
2176110.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21762--------------------------
21763
21764fcgi-app <name>
21765 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21766 document root must be defined.
21767
21768acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21769 Declare or complete an access list.
21770
21771 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21772 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21773 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21774 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21775 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21776
21777docroot <path>
21778 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21779 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21780 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21781
21782index <script-name>
21783 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21784 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21785 is an optional setting.
21786
21787 Example :
21788 index index.php
21789
21790log-stderr global
21791log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021792 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021793 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21794
21795 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21796 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21797
21798pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21799 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21800 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21801 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21802
21803 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21804 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21805 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21806 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21807
21808 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21809 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21810
21811path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021812 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021813 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21814 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21815 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21816 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21817 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21818 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21819 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021820
21821 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021822 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021823 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21824 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21825 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21826 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021827
21828 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021829 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21830 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021831
21832option get-values
21833no option get-values
21834 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21835
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021836 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021837 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21838
21839 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21840 application will accept.
21841
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021842 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21843 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021844
21845 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021846 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021847 option is disabled.
21848
21849 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21850 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21851 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21852 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21853 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21854 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21855
21856option keep-conn
21857no option keep-conn
21858 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21859 sending a response.
21860
21861 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21862 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21863
21864option max-reqs <reqs>
21865 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21866 accept.
21867
21868 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21869 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21870 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21871 to 1.
21872
21873option mpxs-conns
21874no option mpxs-conns
21875 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21876
21877 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
21878 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
21879
21880set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21881 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
21882 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
21883 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
21884 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21885
21886 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
21887 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
21888 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
21889
21890 Example :
21891 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
21892 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
21893
21894 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
21895
21896
2189710.1.2. Proxy section
21898---------------------
21899
21900use-fcgi-app <name>
21901 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
21902
21903 Arguments :
21904 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
21905
21906 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
21907 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
21908 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
21909 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
21910 application may be defined at a time per backend.
21911
21912 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
21913 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
21914 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
21915 application are evaluated.
21916
21917
2191810.1.3. Example
21919---------------
21920
21921 frontend front-http
21922 mode http
21923 bind *:80
21924 bind *:
21925
21926 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
21927 default_backend back-static
21928
21929 backend back-static
21930 mode http
21931 server www A.B.C.D:80
21932
21933 backend back-dynamic
21934 mode http
21935 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
21936 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
21937
21938 fcgi-app php-fpm
21939 log-stderr global
21940 option keep-conn
21941
21942 docroot /var/www/my-app
21943 index index.php
21944 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
21945
21946
2194710.2. Default parameters
21948------------------------
21949
21950A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
21951the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021952script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021953applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
21954
21955 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21956 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
21957 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
21958 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
21959 | | |
21960 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21961 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
21962 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
21963 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
21964 | | application. |
21965 | | |
21966 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21967 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
21968 | | the request. It may not be set. |
21969 | | |
21970 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21971 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
21972 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
21973 | | the application's configuration. |
21974 | | |
21975 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21976 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
21977 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
21978 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
21979 | | |
21980 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21981 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
21982 | | following the part that identifies the script |
21983 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
21984 | | be defined. |
21985 | | |
21986 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21987 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
21988 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
21989 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
21990 | | is not set too. |
21991 | | |
21992 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21993 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
21994 | | set. |
21995 | | |
21996 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21997 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
21998 | | the request. |
21999 | | |
22000 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22001 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
22002 | | client as part of user authentication. |
22003 | | |
22004 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22005 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
22006 | | script to process the request. |
22007 | | |
22008 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22009 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
22010 | | |
22011 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22012 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
22013 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
22014 | | |
22015 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22016 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
22017 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
22018 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
22019 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
22020 | | |
22021 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22022 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
22023 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
22024 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
22025 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
22026 | | side. |
22027 | | |
22028 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22029 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
22030 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
22031 | | connected to. |
22032 | | |
22033 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22034 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
22035 | | |
22036 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb2a50292021-06-11 13:34:42 +020022037 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
22038 | | current HAProxy version. |
22039 | | |
22040 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022041 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
22042 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
22043 | | |
22044 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22045
22046
2204710.3. Limitations
22048------------------
22049
22050The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
22051way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
22052during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
22053establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
22054application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
22055or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
22056message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
22057these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
22058and HTTP servers under the same backend.
22059
22060Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
22061request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
22062requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
22063
22064About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
22065into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
22066fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
22067"http-request" ones.
22068
22069Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
22070FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
22071processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
22072must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
22073here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010022074
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022075
2207611. Address formats
22077-------------------
22078
22079Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
22080address.
22081
22082This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
22083The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
22084of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
22085equivalent is '::'.
22086
22087Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
22088is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
22089
22090This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
22091family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
22092
22093Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
22094configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
22095use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
22096'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
22097
22098Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
22099socket type and the transport method.
22100
22101
2210211.1 Address family prefixes
22103----------------------------
22104
22105'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
22106
22107'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
22108 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
22109 listening.
22110
22111'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
22112 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
22113 on the statement using this address, a port or
22114 a port range may or must be specified.
22115
22116'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22117 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
22118 using this address, a port or a port range
22119 may or must be specified.
22120
22121'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22122 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
22123 using this address, a port or a port range
22124 may or must be specified.
22125
22126'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
22127 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
22128 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
22129 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
22130 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
22131 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
22132
22133'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
22134 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
22135 start by slash '/'.
22136
22137
2213811.2 Socket type prefixes
22139-------------------------
22140
22141Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
22142type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
22143this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
22144This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
22145but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
22146
22147Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
22148instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
22149
22150If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
22151they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
22152report this to the maintainers.
22153
22154'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22155 to "stream"
22156
22157'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22158 to "datagram".
22159
22160
2216111.3 Protocol prefixes
22162----------------------
22163
22164'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22165 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22166 socket type and transport method is forced to
22167 "stream". Depending on the statement using
22168 this address, a port or a port range can or
22169 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22170 of 'stream+ip@'.
22171
22172'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22173 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22174 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22175 statement using this address, a port or port
22176 range can or must be specified.
22177 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22178
22179'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22180 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22181 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22182 statement using this address, a port or port
22183 range can or must be specified.
22184 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22185
22186'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22187 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22188 socket type and transport method is forced to
22189 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
22190 this address, a port or a port range can or
22191 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22192 of 'dgram+ip@'.
22193
22194'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22195 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22196 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22197 the statement using this address, a port or
22198 port range can or must be specified.
22199 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22200
22201'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22202 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22203 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22204 the statement using this address, a port or
22205 port range can or must be specified.
22206 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22207
22208'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22209 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
22210 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
22211
22212'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22213 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
22214 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
22215
22216In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
22217QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22218
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022219/*
22220 * Local variables:
22221 * fill-column: 79
22222 * End:
22223 */